]>
Commit | Line | Data |
---|---|---|
1 | /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */ | |
2 | #ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H | |
3 | #define __NET_CFG80211_H | |
4 | /* | |
5 | * 802.11 device and configuration interface | |
6 | * | |
7 | * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net> | |
8 | * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH | |
9 | * Copyright 2015-2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH | |
10 | * Copyright (C) 2018-2025 Intel Corporation | |
11 | */ | |
12 | ||
13 | #include <linux/ethtool.h> | |
14 | #include <uapi/linux/rfkill.h> | |
15 | #include <linux/netdevice.h> | |
16 | #include <linux/debugfs.h> | |
17 | #include <linux/list.h> | |
18 | #include <linux/bug.h> | |
19 | #include <linux/netlink.h> | |
20 | #include <linux/skbuff.h> | |
21 | #include <linux/nl80211.h> | |
22 | #include <linux/if_ether.h> | |
23 | #include <linux/ieee80211.h> | |
24 | #include <linux/net.h> | |
25 | #include <linux/rfkill.h> | |
26 | #include <net/regulatory.h> | |
27 | ||
28 | /** | |
29 | * DOC: Introduction | |
30 | * | |
31 | * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges | |
32 | * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated | |
33 | * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used | |
34 | * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent | |
35 | * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers | |
36 | * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely. | |
37 | * | |
38 | * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum | |
39 | * use restrictions. | |
40 | */ | |
41 | ||
42 | ||
43 | /** | |
44 | * DOC: Device registration | |
45 | * | |
46 | * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device | |
47 | * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs | |
48 | * described below. | |
49 | * | |
50 | * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each | |
51 | * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each | |
52 | * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with | |
53 | * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's | |
54 | * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes | |
55 | * the wireless part of the interface. Normally this struct is embedded in the | |
56 | * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating | |
57 | * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the | |
58 | * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful. | |
59 | * | |
60 | * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has | |
61 | * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and | |
62 | * structures here describe these capabilities in detail. | |
63 | */ | |
64 | ||
65 | struct wiphy; | |
66 | ||
67 | /* | |
68 | * wireless hardware capability structures | |
69 | */ | |
70 | ||
71 | /** | |
72 | * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags | |
73 | * | |
74 | * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code. | |
75 | * | |
76 | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled. | |
77 | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes | |
78 | * sending probe requests or beaconing. | |
79 | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_PSD: Power spectral density (in dBm) is set for this | |
80 | * channel. | |
81 | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel. | |
82 | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel | |
83 | * is not permitted. | |
84 | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel | |
85 | * is not permitted. | |
86 | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel. | |
87 | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band, | |
88 | * this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this | |
89 | * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels. | |
90 | * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth | |
91 | * restrictions. | |
92 | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band, | |
93 | * this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this | |
94 | * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels. | |
95 | * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth | |
96 | * restrictions. | |
97 | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY | |
98 | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT | |
99 | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted | |
100 | * on this channel. | |
101 | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted | |
102 | * on this channel. | |
103 | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel. | |
104 | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted | |
105 | * on this channel. | |
106 | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted | |
107 | * on this channel. | |
108 | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted | |
109 | * on this channel. | |
110 | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted | |
111 | * on this channel. | |
112 | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted | |
113 | * on this channel. | |
114 | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ: If the driver supports 320 MHz on the band, | |
115 | * this flag indicates that a 320 MHz channel cannot use this | |
116 | * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels. | |
117 | * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth | |
118 | * restrictions. | |
119 | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not permitted on this channel. | |
120 | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DFS_CONCURRENT: See %NL80211_RRF_DFS_CONCURRENT | |
121 | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT: Client connection with VLP AP | |
122 | * not permitted using this channel | |
123 | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT: Client connection with AFC AP | |
124 | * not permitted using this channel | |
125 | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_CAN_MONITOR: This channel can be used for monitor | |
126 | * mode even in the presence of other (regulatory) restrictions, | |
127 | * even if it is otherwise disabled. | |
128 | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_ALLOW_6GHZ_VLP_AP: Allow using this channel for AP operation | |
129 | * with very low power (VLP), even if otherwise set to NO_IR. | |
130 | * @IEEE80211_CHAN_ALLOW_20MHZ_ACTIVITY: Allow activity on a 20 MHz channel, | |
131 | * even if otherwise set to NO_IR. | |
132 | */ | |
133 | enum ieee80211_channel_flags { | |
134 | IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED = BIT(0), | |
135 | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR = BIT(1), | |
136 | IEEE80211_CHAN_PSD = BIT(2), | |
137 | IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR = BIT(3), | |
138 | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS = BIT(4), | |
139 | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS = BIT(5), | |
140 | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM = BIT(6), | |
141 | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ = BIT(7), | |
142 | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ = BIT(8), | |
143 | IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY = BIT(9), | |
144 | IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT = BIT(10), | |
145 | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ = BIT(11), | |
146 | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ = BIT(12), | |
147 | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE = BIT(13), | |
148 | IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ = BIT(14), | |
149 | IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ = BIT(15), | |
150 | IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ = BIT(16), | |
151 | IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ = BIT(17), | |
152 | IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ = BIT(18), | |
153 | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ = BIT(19), | |
154 | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT = BIT(20), | |
155 | IEEE80211_CHAN_DFS_CONCURRENT = BIT(21), | |
156 | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT = BIT(22), | |
157 | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT = BIT(23), | |
158 | IEEE80211_CHAN_CAN_MONITOR = BIT(24), | |
159 | IEEE80211_CHAN_ALLOW_6GHZ_VLP_AP = BIT(25), | |
160 | IEEE80211_CHAN_ALLOW_20MHZ_ACTIVITY = BIT(26), | |
161 | }; | |
162 | ||
163 | #define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \ | |
164 | (IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS) | |
165 | ||
166 | #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS 60000 | |
167 | #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS (30 * 60 * 1000) | |
168 | ||
169 | /** | |
170 | * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition | |
171 | * | |
172 | * This structure describes a single channel for use | |
173 | * with cfg80211. | |
174 | * | |
175 | * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz | |
176 | * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz | |
177 | * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel | |
178 | * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags. | |
179 | * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory | |
180 | * code to support devices with additional restrictions | |
181 | * @band: band this channel belongs to. | |
182 | * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi | |
183 | * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm) | |
184 | * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm) | |
185 | * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon | |
186 | * has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon() | |
187 | * to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band. | |
188 | * @orig_mag: internal use | |
189 | * @orig_mpwr: internal use | |
190 | * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required | |
191 | * on this channel. | |
192 | * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered. | |
193 | * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels. | |
194 | * @psd: power spectral density (in dBm) | |
195 | */ | |
196 | struct ieee80211_channel { | |
197 | enum nl80211_band band; | |
198 | u32 center_freq; | |
199 | u16 freq_offset; | |
200 | u16 hw_value; | |
201 | u32 flags; | |
202 | int max_antenna_gain; | |
203 | int max_power; | |
204 | int max_reg_power; | |
205 | bool beacon_found; | |
206 | u32 orig_flags; | |
207 | int orig_mag, orig_mpwr; | |
208 | enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state; | |
209 | unsigned long dfs_state_entered; | |
210 | unsigned int dfs_cac_ms; | |
211 | s8 psd; | |
212 | }; | |
213 | ||
214 | /** | |
215 | * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags | |
216 | * | |
217 | * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured | |
218 | * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for | |
219 | * different bands/PHY modes. | |
220 | * | |
221 | * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short | |
222 | * preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and | |
223 | * with CCK rates. | |
224 | * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate | |
225 | * when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the | |
226 | * core code when registering the wiphy. | |
227 | * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate | |
228 | * when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the | |
229 | * core code when registering the wiphy. | |
230 | * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate | |
231 | * when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the | |
232 | * core code when registering the wiphy. | |
233 | * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode. | |
234 | * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode | |
235 | * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode | |
236 | */ | |
237 | enum ieee80211_rate_flags { | |
238 | IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = BIT(0), | |
239 | IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A = BIT(1), | |
240 | IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B = BIT(2), | |
241 | IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G = BIT(3), | |
242 | IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G = BIT(4), | |
243 | IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ = BIT(5), | |
244 | IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ = BIT(6), | |
245 | }; | |
246 | ||
247 | /** | |
248 | * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter | |
249 | * | |
250 | * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS | |
251 | * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS | |
252 | * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS | |
253 | * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS | |
254 | * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type | |
255 | */ | |
256 | enum ieee80211_bss_type { | |
257 | IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS, | |
258 | IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS, | |
259 | IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS, | |
260 | IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS, | |
261 | IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY | |
262 | }; | |
263 | ||
264 | /** | |
265 | * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter | |
266 | * | |
267 | * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set | |
268 | * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear | |
269 | * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting | |
270 | */ | |
271 | enum ieee80211_privacy { | |
272 | IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON, | |
273 | IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF, | |
274 | IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY | |
275 | }; | |
276 | ||
277 | #define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x) \ | |
278 | ((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF) | |
279 | ||
280 | /** | |
281 | * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition | |
282 | * | |
283 | * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can | |
284 | * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short | |
285 | * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are | |
286 | * passed around. | |
287 | * | |
288 | * @flags: rate-specific flags from &enum ieee80211_rate_flags | |
289 | * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps | |
290 | * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate | |
291 | * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when | |
292 | * short preamble is used | |
293 | */ | |
294 | struct ieee80211_rate { | |
295 | u32 flags; | |
296 | u16 bitrate; | |
297 | u16 hw_value, hw_value_short; | |
298 | }; | |
299 | ||
300 | /** | |
301 | * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse | |
302 | * | |
303 | * @enable: is the feature enabled. | |
304 | * @sr_ctrl: The SR Control field of SRP element. | |
305 | * @non_srg_max_offset: non-SRG maximum tx power offset | |
306 | * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use | |
307 | * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use | |
308 | * @bss_color_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the BSS color values used by | |
309 | * members of the SRG | |
310 | * @partial_bssid_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the partial BSSID values | |
311 | * used by members of the SRG | |
312 | */ | |
313 | struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd { | |
314 | bool enable; | |
315 | u8 sr_ctrl; | |
316 | u8 non_srg_max_offset; | |
317 | u8 min_offset; | |
318 | u8 max_offset; | |
319 | u8 bss_color_bitmap[8]; | |
320 | u8 partial_bssid_bitmap[8]; | |
321 | }; | |
322 | ||
323 | /** | |
324 | * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring | |
325 | * | |
326 | * @color: the current color. | |
327 | * @enabled: HE BSS color is used | |
328 | * @partial: define the AID equation. | |
329 | */ | |
330 | struct cfg80211_he_bss_color { | |
331 | u8 color; | |
332 | bool enabled; | |
333 | bool partial; | |
334 | }; | |
335 | ||
336 | /** | |
337 | * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities | |
338 | * | |
339 | * This structure describes most essential parameters needed | |
340 | * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA. | |
341 | * | |
342 | * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA | |
343 | * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec | |
344 | * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor | |
345 | * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing | |
346 | * @mcs: Supported MCS rates | |
347 | */ | |
348 | struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap { | |
349 | u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */ | |
350 | bool ht_supported; | |
351 | u8 ampdu_factor; | |
352 | u8 ampdu_density; | |
353 | struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs; | |
354 | }; | |
355 | ||
356 | /** | |
357 | * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities | |
358 | * | |
359 | * This structure describes most essential parameters needed | |
360 | * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA. | |
361 | * | |
362 | * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA | |
363 | * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec | |
364 | * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates | |
365 | */ | |
366 | struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap { | |
367 | bool vht_supported; | |
368 | u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */ | |
369 | struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs; | |
370 | }; | |
371 | ||
372 | #define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN 25 | |
373 | ||
374 | /** | |
375 | * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities | |
376 | * | |
377 | * This structure describes most essential parameters needed | |
378 | * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA. | |
379 | * | |
380 | * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid. | |
381 | * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element. | |
382 | * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations. | |
383 | * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data. | |
384 | */ | |
385 | struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap { | |
386 | bool has_he; | |
387 | struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem; | |
388 | struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp; | |
389 | u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN]; | |
390 | }; | |
391 | ||
392 | /** | |
393 | * struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp - EHT max supported NSS per MCS | |
394 | * | |
395 | * See P802.11be_D1.3 Table 9-401k - "Subfields of the Supported EHT-MCS | |
396 | * and NSS Set field" | |
397 | * | |
398 | * @only_20mhz: MCS/NSS support for 20 MHz-only STA. | |
399 | * @bw: MCS/NSS support for 80, 160 and 320 MHz | |
400 | * @bw._80: MCS/NSS support for BW <= 80 MHz | |
401 | * @bw._160: MCS/NSS support for BW = 160 MHz | |
402 | * @bw._320: MCS/NSS support for BW = 320 MHz | |
403 | */ | |
404 | struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp { | |
405 | union { | |
406 | struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_20mhz_only only_20mhz; | |
407 | struct { | |
408 | struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _80; | |
409 | struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _160; | |
410 | struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _320; | |
411 | } __packed bw; | |
412 | } __packed; | |
413 | } __packed; | |
414 | ||
415 | #define IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN 32 | |
416 | ||
417 | /** | |
418 | * struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap - STA's EHT capabilities | |
419 | * | |
420 | * This structure describes most essential parameters needed | |
421 | * to describe 802.11be EHT capabilities for a STA. | |
422 | * | |
423 | * @has_eht: true iff EHT data is valid. | |
424 | * @eht_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the eht capabilities element. | |
425 | * @eht_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations. | |
426 | * @eht_ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data. | |
427 | */ | |
428 | struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap { | |
429 | bool has_eht; | |
430 | struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem_fixed eht_cap_elem; | |
431 | struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp eht_mcs_nss_supp; | |
432 | u8 eht_ppe_thres[IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN]; | |
433 | }; | |
434 | ||
435 | /* sparse defines __CHECKER__; see Documentation/dev-tools/sparse.rst */ | |
436 | #ifdef __CHECKER__ | |
437 | /* | |
438 | * This is used to mark the sband->iftype_data pointer which is supposed | |
439 | * to be an array with special access semantics (per iftype), but a lot | |
440 | * of code got it wrong in the past, so with this marking sparse will be | |
441 | * noisy when the pointer is used directly. | |
442 | */ | |
443 | # define __iftd __attribute__((noderef, address_space(__iftype_data))) | |
444 | #else | |
445 | # define __iftd | |
446 | #endif /* __CHECKER__ */ | |
447 | ||
448 | /** | |
449 | * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data - sband data per interface type | |
450 | * | |
451 | * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the | |
452 | * interface types defined in @types_mask. Each type in the | |
453 | * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data. | |
454 | * | |
455 | * @types_mask: interface types mask | |
456 | * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities | |
457 | * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a | |
458 | * 6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value). | |
459 | * @eht_cap: STA's EHT capabilities | |
460 | * @vendor_elems: vendor element(s) to advertise | |
461 | * @vendor_elems.data: vendor element(s) data | |
462 | * @vendor_elems.len: vendor element(s) length | |
463 | */ | |
464 | struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data { | |
465 | u16 types_mask; | |
466 | struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap; | |
467 | struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa; | |
468 | struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap; | |
469 | struct { | |
470 | const u8 *data; | |
471 | unsigned int len; | |
472 | } vendor_elems; | |
473 | }; | |
474 | ||
475 | /** | |
476 | * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations | |
477 | * | |
478 | * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz | |
479 | * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz | |
480 | * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz | |
481 | * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz | |
482 | * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz | |
483 | * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz | |
484 | * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz | |
485 | * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and | |
486 | * 2.16GHz+2.16GHz | |
487 | * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and | |
488 | * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz | |
489 | * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and | |
490 | * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz | |
491 | * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz | |
492 | * and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz | |
493 | * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz, | |
494 | * 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz | |
495 | */ | |
496 | enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config { | |
497 | IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4 = 4, | |
498 | IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5 = 5, | |
499 | IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6 = 6, | |
500 | IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7 = 7, | |
501 | IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8 = 8, | |
502 | IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9 = 9, | |
503 | IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10 = 10, | |
504 | IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11 = 11, | |
505 | IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12 = 12, | |
506 | IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13 = 13, | |
507 | IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14 = 14, | |
508 | IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15 = 15, | |
509 | }; | |
510 | ||
511 | /** | |
512 | * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration | |
513 | * | |
514 | * This structure describes most essential parameters needed | |
515 | * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration | |
516 | * | |
517 | * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s) | |
518 | * that are allowed to be used for transmissions. | |
519 | * Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc. | |
520 | * Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported. | |
521 | * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes | |
522 | * the allowed channel bandwidth configurations | |
523 | */ | |
524 | struct ieee80211_edmg { | |
525 | u8 channels; | |
526 | enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config; | |
527 | }; | |
528 | ||
529 | /** | |
530 | * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities | |
531 | * | |
532 | * This structure describes most essential parameters needed | |
533 | * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA. | |
534 | * | |
535 | * @s1g: is STA an S1G STA | |
536 | * @cap: S1G capabilities information | |
537 | * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set | |
538 | */ | |
539 | struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap { | |
540 | bool s1g; | |
541 | u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */ | |
542 | u8 nss_mcs[5]; | |
543 | }; | |
544 | ||
545 | /** | |
546 | * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition | |
547 | * | |
548 | * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy | |
549 | * is able to operate in. | |
550 | * | |
551 | * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with | |
552 | * in this band. | |
553 | * @band: the band this structure represents | |
554 | * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels | |
555 | * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with | |
556 | * in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported | |
557 | * rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM. | |
558 | * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates | |
559 | * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band | |
560 | * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band | |
561 | * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band | |
562 | * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band | |
563 | * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course) | |
564 | * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries | |
565 | * @iftype_data: interface type data entries. Note that the bits in | |
566 | * @types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only | |
567 | * one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of | |
568 | * iftype_data). | |
569 | */ | |
570 | struct ieee80211_supported_band { | |
571 | struct ieee80211_channel *channels; | |
572 | struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates; | |
573 | enum nl80211_band band; | |
574 | int n_channels; | |
575 | int n_bitrates; | |
576 | struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap; | |
577 | struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap; | |
578 | struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap; | |
579 | struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap; | |
580 | u16 n_iftype_data; | |
581 | const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data __iftd *iftype_data; | |
582 | }; | |
583 | ||
584 | /** | |
585 | * _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data - set sband iftype data array | |
586 | * @sband: the sband to initialize | |
587 | * @iftd: the iftype data array pointer | |
588 | * @n_iftd: the length of the iftype data array | |
589 | * | |
590 | * Set the sband iftype data array; use this where the length cannot | |
591 | * be derived from the ARRAY_SIZE() of the argument, but prefer | |
592 | * ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data() where it can be used. | |
593 | */ | |
594 | static inline void | |
595 | _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, | |
596 | const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftd, | |
597 | u16 n_iftd) | |
598 | { | |
599 | sband->iftype_data = (const void __iftd __force *)iftd; | |
600 | sband->n_iftype_data = n_iftd; | |
601 | } | |
602 | ||
603 | /** | |
604 | * ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data - set sband iftype data array | |
605 | * @sband: the sband to initialize | |
606 | * @iftd: the iftype data array | |
607 | */ | |
608 | #define ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftd) \ | |
609 | _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftd, ARRAY_SIZE(iftd)) | |
610 | ||
611 | /** | |
612 | * for_each_sband_iftype_data - iterate sband iftype data entries | |
613 | * @sband: the sband whose iftype_data array to iterate | |
614 | * @i: iterator counter | |
615 | * @iftd: iftype data pointer to set | |
616 | */ | |
617 | #define for_each_sband_iftype_data(sband, i, iftd) \ | |
618 | for (i = 0, iftd = (const void __force *)&(sband)->iftype_data[i]; \ | |
619 | i < (sband)->n_iftype_data; \ | |
620 | i++, iftd = (const void __force *)&(sband)->iftype_data[i]) | |
621 | ||
622 | /** | |
623 | * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype | |
624 | * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on | |
625 | * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype | |
626 | * | |
627 | * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found | |
628 | */ | |
629 | static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data * | |
630 | ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, | |
631 | u8 iftype) | |
632 | { | |
633 | const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data; | |
634 | int i; | |
635 | ||
636 | if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX)) | |
637 | return NULL; | |
638 | ||
639 | if (iftype == NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN) | |
640 | iftype = NL80211_IFTYPE_AP; | |
641 | ||
642 | for_each_sband_iftype_data(sband, i, data) { | |
643 | if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype)) | |
644 | return data; | |
645 | } | |
646 | ||
647 | return NULL; | |
648 | } | |
649 | ||
650 | /** | |
651 | * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype | |
652 | * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on | |
653 | * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype | |
654 | * | |
655 | * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found | |
656 | */ | |
657 | static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap * | |
658 | ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, | |
659 | u8 iftype) | |
660 | { | |
661 | const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = | |
662 | ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype); | |
663 | ||
664 | if (data && data->he_cap.has_he) | |
665 | return &data->he_cap; | |
666 | ||
667 | return NULL; | |
668 | } | |
669 | ||
670 | /** | |
671 | * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities | |
672 | * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on | |
673 | * @iftype: the iftype to search for | |
674 | * | |
675 | * Return: the 6GHz capabilities | |
676 | */ | |
677 | static inline __le16 | |
678 | ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, | |
679 | enum nl80211_iftype iftype) | |
680 | { | |
681 | const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = | |
682 | ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype); | |
683 | ||
684 | if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he)) | |
685 | return 0; | |
686 | ||
687 | return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa; | |
688 | } | |
689 | ||
690 | /** | |
691 | * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap - return ETH capabilities for an sband's iftype | |
692 | * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on | |
693 | * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype | |
694 | * | |
695 | * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or NULL is none found | |
696 | */ | |
697 | static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap * | |
698 | ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, | |
699 | enum nl80211_iftype iftype) | |
700 | { | |
701 | const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = | |
702 | ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype); | |
703 | ||
704 | if (data && data->eht_cap.has_eht) | |
705 | return &data->eht_cap; | |
706 | ||
707 | return NULL; | |
708 | } | |
709 | ||
710 | /** | |
711 | * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree | |
712 | * | |
713 | * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for | |
714 | * | |
715 | * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful | |
716 | * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board | |
717 | * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier). | |
718 | * | |
719 | * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable | |
720 | * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with | |
721 | * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make | |
722 | * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified | |
723 | * without affecting other devices. | |
724 | * | |
725 | * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev. | |
726 | * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first. | |
727 | * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register(). | |
728 | */ | |
729 | #ifdef CONFIG_OF | |
730 | void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy); | |
731 | #else /* CONFIG_OF */ | |
732 | static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy) | |
733 | { | |
734 | } | |
735 | #endif /* !CONFIG_OF */ | |
736 | ||
737 | ||
738 | /* | |
739 | * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods | |
740 | */ | |
741 | ||
742 | /** | |
743 | * DOC: Actions and configuration | |
744 | * | |
745 | * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration | |
746 | * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these | |
747 | * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these | |
748 | * operations use are described separately. | |
749 | * | |
750 | * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status | |
751 | * information via some functions that drivers need to call. | |
752 | * | |
753 | * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described | |
754 | * in a separate chapter. | |
755 | */ | |
756 | ||
757 | #define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\ | |
758 | WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN) | |
759 | ||
760 | /** | |
761 | * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters | |
762 | * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise | |
763 | * %MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set | |
764 | * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames | |
765 | * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface. | |
766 | * If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may | |
767 | * determine the address as needed. | |
768 | * This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the | |
769 | * %NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag. Others may support creating | |
770 | ** only p2p devices with specified MAC. | |
771 | * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets | |
772 | * belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed | |
773 | * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring | |
774 | * MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed | |
775 | */ | |
776 | struct vif_params { | |
777 | u32 flags; | |
778 | int use_4addr; | |
779 | u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN]; | |
780 | const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups; | |
781 | const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr; | |
782 | }; | |
783 | ||
784 | /** | |
785 | * struct key_params - key information | |
786 | * | |
787 | * Information about a key | |
788 | * | |
789 | * @key: key material | |
790 | * @key_len: length of key material | |
791 | * @cipher: cipher suite selector | |
792 | * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used | |
793 | * with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian, | |
794 | * length given by @seq_len. | |
795 | * @seq_len: length of @seq. | |
796 | * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero) | |
797 | * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX) | |
798 | */ | |
799 | struct key_params { | |
800 | const u8 *key; | |
801 | const u8 *seq; | |
802 | int key_len; | |
803 | int seq_len; | |
804 | u16 vlan_id; | |
805 | u32 cipher; | |
806 | enum nl80211_key_mode mode; | |
807 | }; | |
808 | ||
809 | /** | |
810 | * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition | |
811 | * @chan: the (control) channel | |
812 | * @width: channel width | |
813 | * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment | |
814 | * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment | |
815 | * (only with 80+80 MHz) | |
816 | * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration. | |
817 | * If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero), | |
818 | * chan will define the primary channel and all other | |
819 | * parameters are ignored. | |
820 | * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz | |
821 | * @punctured: mask of the punctured 20 MHz subchannels, with | |
822 | * bits turned on being disabled (punctured); numbered | |
823 | * from lower to higher frequency (like in the spec) | |
824 | */ | |
825 | struct cfg80211_chan_def { | |
826 | struct ieee80211_channel *chan; | |
827 | enum nl80211_chan_width width; | |
828 | u32 center_freq1; | |
829 | u32 center_freq2; | |
830 | struct ieee80211_edmg edmg; | |
831 | u16 freq1_offset; | |
832 | u16 punctured; | |
833 | }; | |
834 | ||
835 | /* | |
836 | * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control | |
837 | */ | |
838 | struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask { | |
839 | struct { | |
840 | u32 legacy; | |
841 | u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN]; | |
842 | u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX]; | |
843 | u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX]; | |
844 | enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi; | |
845 | enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi; | |
846 | enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf; | |
847 | } control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; | |
848 | }; | |
849 | ||
850 | ||
851 | /** | |
852 | * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration | |
853 | * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration | |
854 | * of the peer. | |
855 | * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify | |
856 | * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed, | |
857 | * similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp. | |
858 | * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID | |
859 | * @retry_long: retry count value | |
860 | * @retry_short: retry count value | |
861 | * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation | |
862 | * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS | |
863 | * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation | |
864 | * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type | |
865 | * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID | |
866 | */ | |
867 | struct cfg80211_tid_cfg { | |
868 | bool config_override; | |
869 | u8 tids; | |
870 | u64 mask; | |
871 | enum nl80211_tid_config noack; | |
872 | u8 retry_long, retry_short; | |
873 | enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu; | |
874 | enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts; | |
875 | enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu; | |
876 | enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type; | |
877 | struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask; | |
878 | }; | |
879 | ||
880 | /** | |
881 | * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration | |
882 | * @peer: Station's MAC address | |
883 | * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied | |
884 | * @tid_conf: Configuration change info | |
885 | */ | |
886 | struct cfg80211_tid_config { | |
887 | const u8 *peer; | |
888 | u32 n_tid_conf; | |
889 | struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[] __counted_by(n_tid_conf); | |
890 | }; | |
891 | ||
892 | /** | |
893 | * struct cfg80211_fils_aad - FILS AAD data | |
894 | * @macaddr: STA MAC address | |
895 | * @kek: FILS KEK | |
896 | * @kek_len: FILS KEK length | |
897 | * @snonce: STA Nonce | |
898 | * @anonce: AP Nonce | |
899 | */ | |
900 | struct cfg80211_fils_aad { | |
901 | const u8 *macaddr; | |
902 | const u8 *kek; | |
903 | u8 kek_len; | |
904 | const u8 *snonce; | |
905 | const u8 *anonce; | |
906 | }; | |
907 | ||
908 | /** | |
909 | * struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp - enable/disable HW timestamping | |
910 | * @macaddr: peer MAC address. NULL to enable/disable HW timestamping for all | |
911 | * addresses. | |
912 | * @enable: if set, enable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address. | |
913 | * Otherwise disable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address. | |
914 | */ | |
915 | struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp { | |
916 | const u8 *macaddr; | |
917 | bool enable; | |
918 | }; | |
919 | ||
920 | /** | |
921 | * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef | |
922 | * @chandef: the channel definition | |
923 | * | |
924 | * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given | |
925 | * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion. | |
926 | */ | |
927 | static inline enum nl80211_channel_type | |
928 | cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) | |
929 | { | |
930 | switch (chandef->width) { | |
931 | case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT: | |
932 | return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT; | |
933 | case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20: | |
934 | return NL80211_CHAN_HT20; | |
935 | case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40: | |
936 | if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq) | |
937 | return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS; | |
938 | return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS; | |
939 | default: | |
940 | WARN_ON(1); | |
941 | return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT; | |
942 | } | |
943 | } | |
944 | ||
945 | /** | |
946 | * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type | |
947 | * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill | |
948 | * @channel: the control channel | |
949 | * @chantype: the channel type | |
950 | * | |
951 | * Given a channel type, create a channel definition. | |
952 | */ | |
953 | void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | |
954 | struct ieee80211_channel *channel, | |
955 | enum nl80211_channel_type chantype); | |
956 | ||
957 | /** | |
958 | * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical | |
959 | * @chandef1: first channel definition | |
960 | * @chandef2: second channel definition | |
961 | * | |
962 | * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are | |
963 | * identical, %false otherwise. | |
964 | */ | |
965 | static inline bool | |
966 | cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1, | |
967 | const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2) | |
968 | { | |
969 | return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan && | |
970 | chandef1->width == chandef2->width && | |
971 | chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 && | |
972 | chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset && | |
973 | chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2 && | |
974 | chandef1->punctured == chandef2->punctured); | |
975 | } | |
976 | ||
977 | /** | |
978 | * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel | |
979 | * | |
980 | * @chandef: the channel definition | |
981 | * | |
982 | * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise. | |
983 | */ | |
984 | static inline bool | |
985 | cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) | |
986 | { | |
987 | return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config; | |
988 | } | |
989 | ||
990 | /** | |
991 | * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible | |
992 | * @chandef1: first channel definition | |
993 | * @chandef2: second channel definition | |
994 | * | |
995 | * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible, | |
996 | * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise. | |
997 | */ | |
998 | const struct cfg80211_chan_def * | |
999 | cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1, | |
1000 | const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2); | |
1001 | ||
1002 | /** | |
1003 | * nl80211_chan_width_to_mhz - get the channel width in MHz | |
1004 | * @chan_width: the channel width from &enum nl80211_chan_width | |
1005 | * | |
1006 | * Return: channel width in MHz if the chan_width from &enum nl80211_chan_width | |
1007 | * is valid. -1 otherwise. | |
1008 | */ | |
1009 | int nl80211_chan_width_to_mhz(enum nl80211_chan_width chan_width); | |
1010 | ||
1011 | /** | |
1012 | * cfg80211_chandef_get_width - return chandef width in MHz | |
1013 | * @c: chandef to return bandwidth for | |
1014 | * Return: channel width in MHz for the given chandef; note that it returns | |
1015 | * 80 for 80+80 configurations | |
1016 | */ | |
1017 | static inline int cfg80211_chandef_get_width(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *c) | |
1018 | { | |
1019 | return nl80211_chan_width_to_mhz(c->width); | |
1020 | } | |
1021 | ||
1022 | /** | |
1023 | * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid | |
1024 | * @chandef: the channel definition to check | |
1025 | * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise. | |
1026 | */ | |
1027 | bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); | |
1028 | ||
1029 | /** | |
1030 | * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used | |
1031 | * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against | |
1032 | * @chandef: the channel definition to check | |
1033 | * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set | |
1034 | * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise. | |
1035 | */ | |
1036 | bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
1037 | const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | |
1038 | u32 prohibited_flags); | |
1039 | ||
1040 | /** | |
1041 | * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required | |
1042 | * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against | |
1043 | * @chandef: the channel definition to check | |
1044 | * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype | |
1045 | * Returns: | |
1046 | * 1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error | |
1047 | */ | |
1048 | int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
1049 | const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | |
1050 | enum nl80211_iftype iftype); | |
1051 | ||
1052 | /** | |
1053 | * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_usable - checks if chandef is DFS usable and we | |
1054 | * can/need start CAC on such channel | |
1055 | * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against | |
1056 | * @chandef: the channel definition to check | |
1057 | * | |
1058 | * Return: true if all channels available and at least | |
1059 | * one channel requires CAC (NL80211_DFS_USABLE) | |
1060 | */ | |
1061 | bool cfg80211_chandef_dfs_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
1062 | const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); | |
1063 | ||
1064 | /** | |
1065 | * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_cac_time - get the DFS CAC time (in ms) for given | |
1066 | * channel definition | |
1067 | * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against | |
1068 | * @chandef: the channel definition to check | |
1069 | * | |
1070 | * Returns: DFS CAC time (in ms) which applies for this channel definition | |
1071 | */ | |
1072 | unsigned int | |
1073 | cfg80211_chandef_dfs_cac_time(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
1074 | const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); | |
1075 | ||
1076 | /** | |
1077 | * cfg80211_chandef_primary - calculate primary 40/80/160 MHz freq | |
1078 | * @chandef: chandef to calculate for | |
1079 | * @primary_chan_width: primary channel width to calculate center for | |
1080 | * @punctured: punctured sub-channel bitmap, will be recalculated | |
1081 | * according to the new bandwidth, can be %NULL | |
1082 | * | |
1083 | * Returns: the primary 40/80/160 MHz channel center frequency, or -1 | |
1084 | * for errors, updating the punctured bitmap | |
1085 | */ | |
1086 | int cfg80211_chandef_primary(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | |
1087 | enum nl80211_chan_width primary_chan_width, | |
1088 | u16 *punctured); | |
1089 | ||
1090 | /** | |
1091 | * nl80211_send_chandef - sends the channel definition. | |
1092 | * @msg: the msg to send channel definition | |
1093 | * @chandef: the channel definition to check | |
1094 | * | |
1095 | * Returns: 0 if sent the channel definition to msg, < 0 on error | |
1096 | **/ | |
1097 | int nl80211_send_chandef(struct sk_buff *msg, const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); | |
1098 | ||
1099 | /** | |
1100 | * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef | |
1101 | * | |
1102 | * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel | |
1103 | * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual | |
1104 | * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels. | |
1105 | * | |
1106 | * @chandef: channel definition for the channel | |
1107 | * | |
1108 | * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef | |
1109 | */ | |
1110 | static inline int | |
1111 | ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) | |
1112 | { | |
1113 | switch (chandef->width) { | |
1114 | case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: | |
1115 | return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6, | |
1116 | chandef->chan->max_power); | |
1117 | case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: | |
1118 | return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3, | |
1119 | chandef->chan->max_power); | |
1120 | default: | |
1121 | break; | |
1122 | } | |
1123 | return chandef->chan->max_power; | |
1124 | } | |
1125 | ||
1126 | /** | |
1127 | * cfg80211_any_usable_channels - check for usable channels | |
1128 | * @wiphy: the wiphy to check for | |
1129 | * @band_mask: which bands to check on | |
1130 | * @prohibited_flags: which channels to not consider usable, | |
1131 | * %IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED is always taken into account | |
1132 | * | |
1133 | * Return: %true if usable channels found, %false otherwise | |
1134 | */ | |
1135 | bool cfg80211_any_usable_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
1136 | unsigned long band_mask, | |
1137 | u32 prohibited_flags); | |
1138 | ||
1139 | /** | |
1140 | * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags | |
1141 | * | |
1142 | * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in | |
1143 | * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used | |
1144 | * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in | |
1145 | * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in | |
1146 | * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in | |
1147 | * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in | |
1148 | * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in | |
1149 | * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in | |
1150 | * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in | |
1151 | * | |
1152 | * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info | |
1153 | * it has filled in during the get_survey(). | |
1154 | */ | |
1155 | enum survey_info_flags { | |
1156 | SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM = BIT(0), | |
1157 | SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE = BIT(1), | |
1158 | SURVEY_INFO_TIME = BIT(2), | |
1159 | SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY = BIT(3), | |
1160 | SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY = BIT(4), | |
1161 | SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX = BIT(5), | |
1162 | SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX = BIT(6), | |
1163 | SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN = BIT(7), | |
1164 | SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX = BIT(8), | |
1165 | }; | |
1166 | ||
1167 | /** | |
1168 | * struct survey_info - channel survey response | |
1169 | * | |
1170 | * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single | |
1171 | * record to report global statistics | |
1172 | * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags | |
1173 | * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are | |
1174 | * optional | |
1175 | * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel) | |
1176 | * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy | |
1177 | * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy | |
1178 | * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data | |
1179 | * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data | |
1180 | * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning | |
1181 | * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS | |
1182 | * | |
1183 | * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information. | |
1184 | * | |
1185 | * This structure can later be expanded with things like | |
1186 | * channel duty cycle etc. | |
1187 | */ | |
1188 | struct survey_info { | |
1189 | struct ieee80211_channel *channel; | |
1190 | u64 time; | |
1191 | u64 time_busy; | |
1192 | u64 time_ext_busy; | |
1193 | u64 time_rx; | |
1194 | u64 time_tx; | |
1195 | u64 time_scan; | |
1196 | u64 time_bss_rx; | |
1197 | u32 filled; | |
1198 | s8 noise; | |
1199 | }; | |
1200 | ||
1201 | #define CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES 10 | |
1202 | ||
1203 | /** | |
1204 | * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings | |
1205 | * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled | |
1206 | * (from enum nl80211_wpa_versions) | |
1207 | * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset) | |
1208 | * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers | |
1209 | * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites | |
1210 | * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites | |
1211 | * @akm_suites: AKM suites | |
1212 | * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., | |
1213 | * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is | |
1214 | * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by | |
1215 | * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default. | |
1216 | * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be | |
1217 | * allowed through even on unauthorized ports | |
1218 | * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port | |
1219 | * protocol frames. | |
1220 | * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control | |
1221 | * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. | |
1222 | * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control | |
1223 | * port for mac80211 | |
1224 | * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload) | |
1225 | * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE | |
1226 | * offload) | |
1227 | * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload) | |
1228 | * @sae_pwe: The mechanisms allowed for SAE PWE derivation: | |
1229 | * | |
1230 | * NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED | |
1231 | * Not-specified, used to indicate userspace did not specify any | |
1232 | * preference. The driver should follow its internal policy in | |
1233 | * such a scenario. | |
1234 | * | |
1235 | * NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK | |
1236 | * Allow hunting-and-pecking loop only | |
1237 | * | |
1238 | * NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT | |
1239 | * Allow hash-to-element only | |
1240 | * | |
1241 | * NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH | |
1242 | * Allow either hunting-and-pecking loop or hash-to-element | |
1243 | */ | |
1244 | struct cfg80211_crypto_settings { | |
1245 | u32 wpa_versions; | |
1246 | u32 cipher_group; | |
1247 | int n_ciphers_pairwise; | |
1248 | u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES]; | |
1249 | int n_akm_suites; | |
1250 | u32 akm_suites[CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES]; | |
1251 | bool control_port; | |
1252 | __be16 control_port_ethertype; | |
1253 | bool control_port_no_encrypt; | |
1254 | bool control_port_over_nl80211; | |
1255 | bool control_port_no_preauth; | |
1256 | const u8 *psk; | |
1257 | const u8 *sae_pwd; | |
1258 | u8 sae_pwd_len; | |
1259 | enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism sae_pwe; | |
1260 | }; | |
1261 | ||
1262 | /** | |
1263 | * struct cfg80211_mbssid_config - AP settings for multi bssid | |
1264 | * | |
1265 | * @tx_wdev: pointer to the transmitted interface in the MBSSID set | |
1266 | * @tx_link_id: link ID of the transmitted profile in an MLD. | |
1267 | * @index: index of this AP in the multi bssid group. | |
1268 | * @ema: set to true if the beacons should be sent out in EMA mode. | |
1269 | */ | |
1270 | struct cfg80211_mbssid_config { | |
1271 | struct wireless_dev *tx_wdev; | |
1272 | u8 tx_link_id; | |
1273 | u8 index; | |
1274 | bool ema; | |
1275 | }; | |
1276 | ||
1277 | /** | |
1278 | * struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems - Multiple BSSID elements | |
1279 | * | |
1280 | * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems. | |
1281 | * | |
1282 | * @elem: Array of multiple BSSID element(s) to be added into Beacon frames. | |
1283 | * @elem.data: Data for multiple BSSID elements. | |
1284 | * @elem.len: Length of data. | |
1285 | */ | |
1286 | struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems { | |
1287 | u8 cnt; | |
1288 | struct { | |
1289 | const u8 *data; | |
1290 | size_t len; | |
1291 | } elem[] __counted_by(cnt); | |
1292 | }; | |
1293 | ||
1294 | /** | |
1295 | * struct cfg80211_rnr_elems - Reduced neighbor report (RNR) elements | |
1296 | * | |
1297 | * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems. | |
1298 | * | |
1299 | * @elem: Array of RNR element(s) to be added into Beacon frames. | |
1300 | * @elem.data: Data for RNR elements. | |
1301 | * @elem.len: Length of data. | |
1302 | */ | |
1303 | struct cfg80211_rnr_elems { | |
1304 | u8 cnt; | |
1305 | struct { | |
1306 | const u8 *data; | |
1307 | size_t len; | |
1308 | } elem[] __counted_by(cnt); | |
1309 | }; | |
1310 | ||
1311 | /** | |
1312 | * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data | |
1313 | * @link_id: the link ID for the AP MLD link sending this beacon | |
1314 | * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE) | |
1315 | * or %NULL if not changed | |
1316 | * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE) | |
1317 | * or %NULL if not changed | |
1318 | * @head_len: length of @head | |
1319 | * @tail_len: length of @tail | |
1320 | * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL | |
1321 | * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets | |
1322 | * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response | |
1323 | * frames or %NULL | |
1324 | * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets | |
1325 | * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association | |
1326 | * Response frames or %NULL | |
1327 | * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets | |
1328 | * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp) | |
1329 | * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only) | |
1330 | * @mbssid_ies: multiple BSSID elements | |
1331 | * @rnr_ies: reduced neighbor report elements | |
1332 | * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change | |
1333 | * (which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data) | |
1334 | * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token | |
1335 | * (measurement type 8) | |
1336 | * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement | |
1337 | * Token (measurement type 11) | |
1338 | * @lci_len: LCI data length | |
1339 | * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length | |
1340 | * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings | |
1341 | * @he_bss_color_valid: indicates whether bss color | |
1342 | * attribute is present in beacon data or not. | |
1343 | */ | |
1344 | struct cfg80211_beacon_data { | |
1345 | unsigned int link_id; | |
1346 | ||
1347 | const u8 *head, *tail; | |
1348 | const u8 *beacon_ies; | |
1349 | const u8 *proberesp_ies; | |
1350 | const u8 *assocresp_ies; | |
1351 | const u8 *probe_resp; | |
1352 | const u8 *lci; | |
1353 | const u8 *civicloc; | |
1354 | struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems *mbssid_ies; | |
1355 | struct cfg80211_rnr_elems *rnr_ies; | |
1356 | s8 ftm_responder; | |
1357 | ||
1358 | size_t head_len, tail_len; | |
1359 | size_t beacon_ies_len; | |
1360 | size_t proberesp_ies_len; | |
1361 | size_t assocresp_ies_len; | |
1362 | size_t probe_resp_len; | |
1363 | size_t lci_len; | |
1364 | size_t civicloc_len; | |
1365 | struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color; | |
1366 | bool he_bss_color_valid; | |
1367 | }; | |
1368 | ||
1369 | struct mac_address { | |
1370 | u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; | |
1371 | }; | |
1372 | ||
1373 | /** | |
1374 | * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data | |
1375 | * | |
1376 | * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's | |
1377 | * entry specified by mac_addr | |
1378 | * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed | |
1379 | * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL | |
1380 | */ | |
1381 | struct cfg80211_acl_data { | |
1382 | enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy; | |
1383 | int n_acl_entries; | |
1384 | ||
1385 | /* Keep it last */ | |
1386 | struct mac_address mac_addrs[] __counted_by(n_acl_entries); | |
1387 | }; | |
1388 | ||
1389 | /** | |
1390 | * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from | |
1391 | * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail. | |
1392 | * | |
1393 | * @update: Set to true if the feature configuration should be updated. | |
1394 | * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) | |
1395 | * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) | |
1396 | * @tmpl_len: Template length | |
1397 | * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action | |
1398 | * frame headers. | |
1399 | */ | |
1400 | struct cfg80211_fils_discovery { | |
1401 | bool update; | |
1402 | u32 min_interval; | |
1403 | u32 max_interval; | |
1404 | size_t tmpl_len; | |
1405 | const u8 *tmpl; | |
1406 | }; | |
1407 | ||
1408 | /** | |
1409 | * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe | |
1410 | * response parameters in 6GHz. | |
1411 | * | |
1412 | * @update: Set to true if the feature configuration should be updated. | |
1413 | * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned | |
1414 | * in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive | |
1415 | * scanning | |
1416 | * @tmpl_len: Template length | |
1417 | * @tmpl: Template data for probe response | |
1418 | */ | |
1419 | struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp { | |
1420 | bool update; | |
1421 | u32 interval; | |
1422 | size_t tmpl_len; | |
1423 | const u8 *tmpl; | |
1424 | }; | |
1425 | ||
1426 | /** | |
1427 | * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration | |
1428 | * | |
1429 | * Used to configure an AP interface. | |
1430 | * | |
1431 | * @chandef: defines the channel to use | |
1432 | * @beacon: beacon data | |
1433 | * @beacon_interval: beacon interval | |
1434 | * @dtim_period: DTIM period | |
1435 | * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from | |
1436 | * user space) | |
1437 | * @ssid_len: length of @ssid | |
1438 | * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames | |
1439 | * @crypto: crypto settings | |
1440 | * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy | |
1441 | * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) | |
1442 | * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity. | |
1443 | * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window | |
1444 | * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS | |
1445 | * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for | |
1446 | * MAC address based access control | |
1447 | * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG | |
1448 | * networks. | |
1449 | * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons | |
1450 | * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled) | |
1451 | * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled) | |
1452 | * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled) | |
1453 | * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled) | |
1454 | * @eht_oper: EHT operation IE (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled) | |
1455 | * @ht_required: stations must support HT | |
1456 | * @vht_required: stations must support VHT | |
1457 | * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time | |
1458 | * @he_required: stations must support HE | |
1459 | * @sae_h2e_required: stations must support direct H2E technique in SAE | |
1460 | * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags | |
1461 | * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings | |
1462 | * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled) | |
1463 | * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters | |
1464 | * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters | |
1465 | * @mbssid_config: AP settings for multiple bssid | |
1466 | */ | |
1467 | struct cfg80211_ap_settings { | |
1468 | struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; | |
1469 | ||
1470 | struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon; | |
1471 | ||
1472 | int beacon_interval, dtim_period; | |
1473 | const u8 *ssid; | |
1474 | size_t ssid_len; | |
1475 | enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid; | |
1476 | struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; | |
1477 | bool privacy; | |
1478 | enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; | |
1479 | int inactivity_timeout; | |
1480 | u8 p2p_ctwindow; | |
1481 | bool p2p_opp_ps; | |
1482 | const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl; | |
1483 | bool pbss; | |
1484 | struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate; | |
1485 | ||
1486 | const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap; | |
1487 | const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap; | |
1488 | const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap; | |
1489 | const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper; | |
1490 | const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_cap; | |
1491 | const struct ieee80211_eht_operation *eht_oper; | |
1492 | bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required, sae_h2e_required; | |
1493 | bool twt_responder; | |
1494 | u32 flags; | |
1495 | struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd; | |
1496 | struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery; | |
1497 | struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp; | |
1498 | struct cfg80211_mbssid_config mbssid_config; | |
1499 | }; | |
1500 | ||
1501 | ||
1502 | /** | |
1503 | * struct cfg80211_ap_update - AP configuration update | |
1504 | * | |
1505 | * Subset of &struct cfg80211_ap_settings, for updating a running AP. | |
1506 | * | |
1507 | * @beacon: beacon data | |
1508 | * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters | |
1509 | * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters | |
1510 | */ | |
1511 | struct cfg80211_ap_update { | |
1512 | struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon; | |
1513 | struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery; | |
1514 | struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp; | |
1515 | }; | |
1516 | ||
1517 | /** | |
1518 | * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings | |
1519 | * | |
1520 | * Used for channel switch | |
1521 | * | |
1522 | * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch | |
1523 | * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch | |
1524 | * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail) | |
1525 | * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response | |
1526 | * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail) | |
1527 | * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response | |
1528 | * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel | |
1529 | * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel | |
1530 | * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing | |
1531 | * @count: number of beacons until switch | |
1532 | * @link_id: defines the link on which channel switch is expected during | |
1533 | * MLO. 0 in case of non-MLO. | |
1534 | */ | |
1535 | struct cfg80211_csa_settings { | |
1536 | struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; | |
1537 | struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa; | |
1538 | const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon; | |
1539 | const u16 *counter_offsets_presp; | |
1540 | unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon; | |
1541 | unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp; | |
1542 | struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after; | |
1543 | bool radar_required; | |
1544 | bool block_tx; | |
1545 | u8 count; | |
1546 | u8 link_id; | |
1547 | }; | |
1548 | ||
1549 | /** | |
1550 | * struct cfg80211_color_change_settings - color change settings | |
1551 | * | |
1552 | * Used for bss color change | |
1553 | * | |
1554 | * @beacon_color_change: beacon data while performing the color countdown | |
1555 | * @counter_offset_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail) | |
1556 | * @counter_offset_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response | |
1557 | * @beacon_next: beacon data to be used after the color change | |
1558 | * @count: number of beacons until the color change | |
1559 | * @color: the color used after the change | |
1560 | * @link_id: defines the link on which color change is expected during MLO. | |
1561 | * 0 in case of non-MLO. | |
1562 | */ | |
1563 | struct cfg80211_color_change_settings { | |
1564 | struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_color_change; | |
1565 | u16 counter_offset_beacon; | |
1566 | u16 counter_offset_presp; | |
1567 | struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_next; | |
1568 | u8 count; | |
1569 | u8 color; | |
1570 | u8 link_id; | |
1571 | }; | |
1572 | ||
1573 | /** | |
1574 | * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations | |
1575 | * | |
1576 | * Used to pass interface combination parameters | |
1577 | * | |
1578 | * @radio_idx: wiphy radio index or -1 for global | |
1579 | * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want | |
1580 | * to use for verification | |
1581 | * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel | |
1582 | * width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of | |
1583 | * &struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths | |
1584 | * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface | |
1585 | * type. The index is the interface type as specified in &enum | |
1586 | * nl80211_iftype. | |
1587 | * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface | |
1588 | * that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of | |
1589 | * the verification | |
1590 | */ | |
1591 | struct iface_combination_params { | |
1592 | int radio_idx; | |
1593 | int num_different_channels; | |
1594 | u8 radar_detect; | |
1595 | int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES]; | |
1596 | u32 new_beacon_int; | |
1597 | }; | |
1598 | ||
1599 | /** | |
1600 | * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply | |
1601 | * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp) | |
1602 | * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability | |
1603 | * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state | |
1604 | * | |
1605 | * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling, | |
1606 | * for those that don't these flags will are used. | |
1607 | */ | |
1608 | enum station_parameters_apply_mask { | |
1609 | STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0), | |
1610 | STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1), | |
1611 | STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2), | |
1612 | }; | |
1613 | ||
1614 | /** | |
1615 | * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration | |
1616 | * | |
1617 | * Used to configure txpower for station. | |
1618 | * | |
1619 | * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power | |
1620 | * is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be | |
1621 | * overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx | |
1622 | * power per-interface or per-station. | |
1623 | * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power | |
1624 | * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC | |
1625 | * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power. | |
1626 | * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for | |
1627 | * per peer TPC. | |
1628 | */ | |
1629 | struct sta_txpwr { | |
1630 | s16 power; | |
1631 | enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type; | |
1632 | }; | |
1633 | ||
1634 | /** | |
1635 | * struct link_station_parameters - link station parameters | |
1636 | * | |
1637 | * Used to change and create a new link station. | |
1638 | * | |
1639 | * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station | |
1640 | * @link_id: the link id (-1 for non-MLD station) | |
1641 | * @link_mac: MAC address of the link | |
1642 | * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format | |
1643 | * (or NULL for no change) | |
1644 | * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates | |
1645 | * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station | |
1646 | * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station | |
1647 | * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification | |
1648 | * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used | |
1649 | * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station | |
1650 | * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities | |
1651 | * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station | |
1652 | * @txpwr_set: txpwr field is set | |
1653 | * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station | |
1654 | * @eht_capa: EHT capabilities of station | |
1655 | * @eht_capa_len: the length of the EHT capabilities | |
1656 | */ | |
1657 | struct link_station_parameters { | |
1658 | const u8 *mld_mac; | |
1659 | int link_id; | |
1660 | const u8 *link_mac; | |
1661 | const u8 *supported_rates; | |
1662 | u8 supported_rates_len; | |
1663 | const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa; | |
1664 | const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa; | |
1665 | u8 opmode_notif; | |
1666 | bool opmode_notif_used; | |
1667 | const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa; | |
1668 | u8 he_capa_len; | |
1669 | struct sta_txpwr txpwr; | |
1670 | bool txpwr_set; | |
1671 | const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa; | |
1672 | const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_capa; | |
1673 | u8 eht_capa_len; | |
1674 | }; | |
1675 | ||
1676 | /** | |
1677 | * struct link_station_del_parameters - link station deletion parameters | |
1678 | * | |
1679 | * Used to delete a link station entry (or all stations). | |
1680 | * | |
1681 | * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station | |
1682 | * @link_id: the link id | |
1683 | */ | |
1684 | struct link_station_del_parameters { | |
1685 | const u8 *mld_mac; | |
1686 | u32 link_id; | |
1687 | }; | |
1688 | ||
1689 | /** | |
1690 | * struct cfg80211_ttlm_params: TID to link mapping parameters | |
1691 | * | |
1692 | * Used for setting a TID to link mapping. | |
1693 | * | |
1694 | * @dlink: Downlink TID to link mapping, as defined in section 9.4.2.314 | |
1695 | * (TID-To-Link Mapping element) in Draft P802.11be_D4.0. | |
1696 | * @ulink: Uplink TID to link mapping, as defined in section 9.4.2.314 | |
1697 | * (TID-To-Link Mapping element) in Draft P802.11be_D4.0. | |
1698 | */ | |
1699 | struct cfg80211_ttlm_params { | |
1700 | u16 dlink[8]; | |
1701 | u16 ulink[8]; | |
1702 | }; | |
1703 | ||
1704 | /** | |
1705 | * struct station_parameters - station parameters | |
1706 | * | |
1707 | * Used to change and create a new station. | |
1708 | * | |
1709 | * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to | |
1710 | * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed | |
1711 | * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...)) | |
1712 | * @sta_flags_set: station flags values | |
1713 | * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...)) | |
1714 | * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change | |
1715 | * @aid: AID or zero for no change | |
1716 | * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero) | |
1717 | * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change | |
1718 | * @plink_action: plink action to take | |
1719 | * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station | |
1720 | * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format | |
1721 | * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field | |
1722 | * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the | |
1723 | * QoS info field (but already shifted down) | |
1724 | * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed | |
1725 | * (for those that don't have a natural "no change" value), | |
1726 | * see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask | |
1727 | * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set | |
1728 | * to unknown) | |
1729 | * @capability: station capability | |
1730 | * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station | |
1731 | * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities | |
1732 | * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format | |
1733 | * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels | |
1734 | * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format | |
1735 | * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes | |
1736 | * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism | |
1737 | * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station | |
1738 | * @eml_cap_present: Specifies if EML capabilities field (@eml_cap) is | |
1739 | * present/updated | |
1740 | * @eml_cap: EML capabilities of this station | |
1741 | * @link_sta_params: link related params. | |
1742 | */ | |
1743 | struct station_parameters { | |
1744 | struct net_device *vlan; | |
1745 | u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set; | |
1746 | u32 sta_modify_mask; | |
1747 | int listen_interval; | |
1748 | u16 aid; | |
1749 | u16 vlan_id; | |
1750 | u16 peer_aid; | |
1751 | u8 plink_action; | |
1752 | u8 plink_state; | |
1753 | u8 uapsd_queues; | |
1754 | u8 max_sp; | |
1755 | enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm; | |
1756 | u16 capability; | |
1757 | const u8 *ext_capab; | |
1758 | u8 ext_capab_len; | |
1759 | const u8 *supported_channels; | |
1760 | u8 supported_channels_len; | |
1761 | const u8 *supported_oper_classes; | |
1762 | u8 supported_oper_classes_len; | |
1763 | int support_p2p_ps; | |
1764 | u16 airtime_weight; | |
1765 | bool eml_cap_present; | |
1766 | u16 eml_cap; | |
1767 | struct link_station_parameters link_sta_params; | |
1768 | }; | |
1769 | ||
1770 | /** | |
1771 | * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters | |
1772 | * | |
1773 | * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations). | |
1774 | * | |
1775 | * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations | |
1776 | * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal | |
1777 | * (10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication) | |
1778 | * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame | |
1779 | * @link_id: Link ID indicating a link that stations to be flushed must be | |
1780 | * using; valid only for MLO, but can also be -1 for MLO to really | |
1781 | * remove all stations. | |
1782 | */ | |
1783 | struct station_del_parameters { | |
1784 | const u8 *mac; | |
1785 | u8 subtype; | |
1786 | u16 reason_code; | |
1787 | int link_id; | |
1788 | }; | |
1789 | ||
1790 | /** | |
1791 | * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified | |
1792 | * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface | |
1793 | * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still | |
1794 | * unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted) | |
1795 | * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has | |
1796 | * the AP MLME in the device | |
1797 | * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface | |
1798 | * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station | |
1799 | * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry | |
1800 | * while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when | |
1801 | * being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is | |
1802 | * supported/used) | |
1803 | * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active | |
1804 | * entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace) | |
1805 | * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed) | |
1806 | * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed) | |
1807 | */ | |
1808 | enum cfg80211_station_type { | |
1809 | CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT, | |
1810 | CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC, | |
1811 | CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT, | |
1812 | CFG80211_STA_AP_STA, | |
1813 | CFG80211_STA_IBSS, | |
1814 | CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP, | |
1815 | CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE, | |
1816 | CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL, | |
1817 | CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER, | |
1818 | }; | |
1819 | ||
1820 | /** | |
1821 | * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes | |
1822 | * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on | |
1823 | * @params: the new parameters for a station | |
1824 | * @statype: the type of station being modified | |
1825 | * | |
1826 | * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function | |
1827 | * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that | |
1828 | * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable. | |
1829 | * | |
1830 | * Return: 0 if the change is acceptable, otherwise an error code. Note that | |
1831 | * it may modify the parameters for backward compatibility reasons, so don't | |
1832 | * use them before calling this. | |
1833 | */ | |
1834 | int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
1835 | struct station_parameters *params, | |
1836 | enum cfg80211_station_type statype); | |
1837 | ||
1838 | /** | |
1839 | * enum rate_info_flags - bitrate info flags | |
1840 | * | |
1841 | * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission | |
1842 | * type for 802.11n transmissions. | |
1843 | * | |
1844 | * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS | |
1845 | * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS | |
1846 | * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval | |
1847 | * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS | |
1848 | * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information | |
1849 | * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode | |
1850 | * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG: 60GHz extended SC MCS | |
1851 | * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS information | |
1852 | * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS: MCS field filled with S1G MCS | |
1853 | */ | |
1854 | enum rate_info_flags { | |
1855 | RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS = BIT(0), | |
1856 | RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS = BIT(1), | |
1857 | RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI = BIT(2), | |
1858 | RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG = BIT(3), | |
1859 | RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS = BIT(4), | |
1860 | RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG = BIT(5), | |
1861 | RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG = BIT(6), | |
1862 | RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS = BIT(7), | |
1863 | RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS = BIT(8), | |
1864 | }; | |
1865 | ||
1866 | /** | |
1867 | * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information | |
1868 | * | |
1869 | * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth. | |
1870 | * | |
1871 | * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth | |
1872 | * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth | |
1873 | * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth | |
1874 | * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth | |
1875 | * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth | |
1876 | * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth | |
1877 | * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation | |
1878 | * @RATE_INFO_BW_320: 320 MHz bandwidth | |
1879 | * @RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU: bandwidth determined by EHT RU allocation | |
1880 | * @RATE_INFO_BW_1: 1 MHz bandwidth | |
1881 | * @RATE_INFO_BW_2: 2 MHz bandwidth | |
1882 | * @RATE_INFO_BW_4: 4 MHz bandwidth | |
1883 | * @RATE_INFO_BW_8: 8 MHz bandwidth | |
1884 | * @RATE_INFO_BW_16: 16 MHz bandwidth | |
1885 | */ | |
1886 | enum rate_info_bw { | |
1887 | RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0, | |
1888 | RATE_INFO_BW_5, | |
1889 | RATE_INFO_BW_10, | |
1890 | RATE_INFO_BW_40, | |
1891 | RATE_INFO_BW_80, | |
1892 | RATE_INFO_BW_160, | |
1893 | RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU, | |
1894 | RATE_INFO_BW_320, | |
1895 | RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU, | |
1896 | RATE_INFO_BW_1, | |
1897 | RATE_INFO_BW_2, | |
1898 | RATE_INFO_BW_4, | |
1899 | RATE_INFO_BW_8, | |
1900 | RATE_INFO_BW_16, | |
1901 | }; | |
1902 | ||
1903 | /** | |
1904 | * struct rate_info - bitrate information | |
1905 | * | |
1906 | * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate | |
1907 | * | |
1908 | * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags | |
1909 | * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg | |
1910 | * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE/EHT/S1G rate | |
1911 | * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only) | |
1912 | * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw) | |
1913 | * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi) | |
1914 | * @he_dcm: HE DCM value | |
1915 | * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc, | |
1916 | * only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU) | |
1917 | * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4) | |
1918 | * @eht_gi: EHT guard interval (from &enum nl80211_eht_gi) | |
1919 | * @eht_ru_alloc: EHT RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc, | |
1920 | * only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU) | |
1921 | */ | |
1922 | struct rate_info { | |
1923 | u16 flags; | |
1924 | u16 legacy; | |
1925 | u8 mcs; | |
1926 | u8 nss; | |
1927 | u8 bw; | |
1928 | u8 he_gi; | |
1929 | u8 he_dcm; | |
1930 | u8 he_ru_alloc; | |
1931 | u8 n_bonded_ch; | |
1932 | u8 eht_gi; | |
1933 | u8 eht_ru_alloc; | |
1934 | }; | |
1935 | ||
1936 | /** | |
1937 | * enum bss_param_flags - bitrate info flags | |
1938 | * | |
1939 | * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission | |
1940 | * type for 802.11n transmissions. | |
1941 | * | |
1942 | * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled | |
1943 | * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled | |
1944 | * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled | |
1945 | */ | |
1946 | enum bss_param_flags { | |
1947 | BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT = BIT(0), | |
1948 | BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE = BIT(1), | |
1949 | BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME = BIT(2), | |
1950 | }; | |
1951 | ||
1952 | /** | |
1953 | * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station | |
1954 | * | |
1955 | * Information about the currently associated BSS | |
1956 | * | |
1957 | * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags | |
1958 | * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS | |
1959 | * @beacon_interval: beacon interval | |
1960 | */ | |
1961 | struct sta_bss_parameters { | |
1962 | u8 flags; | |
1963 | u8 dtim_period; | |
1964 | u16 beacon_interval; | |
1965 | }; | |
1966 | ||
1967 | /** | |
1968 | * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID | |
1969 | * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to | |
1970 | * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled | |
1971 | * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged | |
1972 | * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged | |
1973 | * @flows: number of new flows seen | |
1974 | * @drops: total number of packets dropped | |
1975 | * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE | |
1976 | * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow | |
1977 | * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow | |
1978 | * @collisions: number of hash collisions | |
1979 | * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued | |
1980 | * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued | |
1981 | * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported | |
1982 | */ | |
1983 | struct cfg80211_txq_stats { | |
1984 | u32 filled; | |
1985 | u32 backlog_bytes; | |
1986 | u32 backlog_packets; | |
1987 | u32 flows; | |
1988 | u32 drops; | |
1989 | u32 ecn_marks; | |
1990 | u32 overlimit; | |
1991 | u32 overmemory; | |
1992 | u32 collisions; | |
1993 | u32 tx_bytes; | |
1994 | u32 tx_packets; | |
1995 | u32 max_flows; | |
1996 | }; | |
1997 | ||
1998 | /** | |
1999 | * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics | |
2000 | * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to | |
2001 | * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled | |
2002 | * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs | |
2003 | * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs | |
2004 | * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for | |
2005 | * transmitted MSDUs | |
2006 | * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs | |
2007 | * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics | |
2008 | */ | |
2009 | struct cfg80211_tid_stats { | |
2010 | u32 filled; | |
2011 | u64 rx_msdu; | |
2012 | u64 tx_msdu; | |
2013 | u64 tx_msdu_retries; | |
2014 | u64 tx_msdu_failed; | |
2015 | struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats; | |
2016 | }; | |
2017 | ||
2018 | #define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS 4 | |
2019 | ||
2020 | /** | |
2021 | * struct station_info - station information | |
2022 | * | |
2023 | * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station. | |
2024 | * | |
2025 | * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to | |
2026 | * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them | |
2027 | * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected | |
2028 | * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds | |
2029 | * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association | |
2030 | * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station | |
2031 | * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station | |
2032 | * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type. | |
2033 | * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_. | |
2034 | * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type. | |
2035 | * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_. | |
2036 | * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg | |
2037 | * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm | |
2038 | * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm | |
2039 | * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station | |
2040 | * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station | |
2041 | * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station | |
2042 | * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station | |
2043 | * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs) | |
2044 | * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK) | |
2045 | * @rx_dropped_misc: Dropped for un-specified reason. | |
2046 | * @bss_param: current BSS parameters | |
2047 | * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps. | |
2048 | * This number should increase every time the list of stations | |
2049 | * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that | |
2050 | * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot. | |
2051 | * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered. | |
2052 | * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request. | |
2053 | * This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use | |
2054 | * user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for | |
2055 | * the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs. | |
2056 | * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets. | |
2057 | * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values | |
2058 | * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host. | |
2059 | * @llid: mesh local link id | |
2060 | * @plid: mesh peer link id | |
2061 | * @plink_state: mesh peer link state | |
2062 | * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate | |
2063 | * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server | |
2064 | * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric. | |
2065 | * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode | |
2066 | * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode | |
2067 | * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode | |
2068 | * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers) | |
2069 | * towards this station. | |
2070 | * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer | |
2071 | * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received | |
2072 | * from this peer | |
2073 | * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer | |
2074 | * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer | |
2075 | * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight | |
2076 | * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last | |
2077 | * (IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs. | |
2078 | * Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL. | |
2079 | * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame. | |
2080 | * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has | |
2081 | * been sent. | |
2082 | * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station | |
2083 | * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with | |
2084 | * an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the | |
2085 | * received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address. | |
2086 | * @mlo_params_valid: Indicates @assoc_link_id and @mld_addr fields are filled | |
2087 | * by driver. Drivers use this only in cfg80211_new_sta() calls when AP | |
2088 | * MLD's MLME/SME is offload to driver. Drivers won't fill this | |
2089 | * information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and | |
2090 | * dump_station() callbacks. | |
2091 | * @assoc_link_id: Indicates MLO link ID of the AP, with which the station | |
2092 | * completed (re)association. This information filled for both MLO | |
2093 | * and non-MLO STA connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD. | |
2094 | * @mld_addr: For MLO STA connection, filled with MLD address of the station. | |
2095 | * For non-MLO STA connection, filled with all zeros. | |
2096 | * @assoc_resp_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Response. | |
2097 | * This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use user | |
2098 | * space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided only for the | |
2099 | * cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs. Drivers won't | |
2100 | * fill this information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and | |
2101 | * dump_station() callbacks. User space needs this information to determine | |
2102 | * the accepted and rejected affiliated links of the connected station. | |
2103 | * @assoc_resp_ies_len: Length of @assoc_resp_ies buffer in octets. | |
2104 | */ | |
2105 | struct station_info { | |
2106 | u64 filled; | |
2107 | u32 connected_time; | |
2108 | u32 inactive_time; | |
2109 | u64 assoc_at; | |
2110 | u64 rx_bytes; | |
2111 | u64 tx_bytes; | |
2112 | s8 signal; | |
2113 | s8 signal_avg; | |
2114 | ||
2115 | u8 chains; | |
2116 | s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; | |
2117 | s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; | |
2118 | ||
2119 | struct rate_info txrate; | |
2120 | struct rate_info rxrate; | |
2121 | u32 rx_packets; | |
2122 | u32 tx_packets; | |
2123 | u32 tx_retries; | |
2124 | u32 tx_failed; | |
2125 | u32 rx_dropped_misc; | |
2126 | struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param; | |
2127 | struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags; | |
2128 | ||
2129 | int generation; | |
2130 | ||
2131 | u32 beacon_loss_count; | |
2132 | ||
2133 | const u8 *assoc_req_ies; | |
2134 | size_t assoc_req_ies_len; | |
2135 | ||
2136 | s64 t_offset; | |
2137 | u16 llid; | |
2138 | u16 plid; | |
2139 | u8 plink_state; | |
2140 | u8 connected_to_gate; | |
2141 | u8 connected_to_as; | |
2142 | u32 airtime_link_metric; | |
2143 | enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm; | |
2144 | enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm; | |
2145 | enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm; | |
2146 | ||
2147 | u32 expected_throughput; | |
2148 | ||
2149 | u16 airtime_weight; | |
2150 | ||
2151 | s8 ack_signal; | |
2152 | s8 avg_ack_signal; | |
2153 | struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid; | |
2154 | ||
2155 | u64 tx_duration; | |
2156 | u64 rx_duration; | |
2157 | u64 rx_beacon; | |
2158 | u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg; | |
2159 | ||
2160 | u32 rx_mpdu_count; | |
2161 | u32 fcs_err_count; | |
2162 | ||
2163 | bool mlo_params_valid; | |
2164 | u8 assoc_link_id; | |
2165 | u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | |
2166 | const u8 *assoc_resp_ies; | |
2167 | size_t assoc_resp_ies_len; | |
2168 | }; | |
2169 | ||
2170 | /** | |
2171 | * struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs - sub specs limit | |
2172 | * @power: power limitation in 0.25dbm | |
2173 | * @freq_range_index: index the power limitation applies to | |
2174 | */ | |
2175 | struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs { | |
2176 | s32 power; | |
2177 | u32 freq_range_index; | |
2178 | }; | |
2179 | ||
2180 | /** | |
2181 | * struct cfg80211_sar_specs - sar limit specs | |
2182 | * @type: it's set with power in 0.25dbm or other types | |
2183 | * @num_sub_specs: number of sar sub specs | |
2184 | * @sub_specs: memory to hold the sar sub specs | |
2185 | */ | |
2186 | struct cfg80211_sar_specs { | |
2187 | enum nl80211_sar_type type; | |
2188 | u32 num_sub_specs; | |
2189 | struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs sub_specs[] __counted_by(num_sub_specs); | |
2190 | }; | |
2191 | ||
2192 | ||
2193 | /** | |
2194 | * struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges - sar frequency ranges | |
2195 | * @start_freq: start range edge frequency | |
2196 | * @end_freq: end range edge frequency | |
2197 | */ | |
2198 | struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges { | |
2199 | u32 start_freq; | |
2200 | u32 end_freq; | |
2201 | }; | |
2202 | ||
2203 | /** | |
2204 | * struct cfg80211_sar_capa - sar limit capability | |
2205 | * @type: it's set via power in 0.25dbm or other types | |
2206 | * @num_freq_ranges: number of frequency ranges | |
2207 | * @freq_ranges: memory to hold the freq ranges. | |
2208 | * | |
2209 | * Note: WLAN driver may append new ranges or split an existing | |
2210 | * range to small ones and then append them. | |
2211 | */ | |
2212 | struct cfg80211_sar_capa { | |
2213 | enum nl80211_sar_type type; | |
2214 | u32 num_freq_ranges; | |
2215 | const struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges *freq_ranges; | |
2216 | }; | |
2217 | ||
2218 | #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211) | |
2219 | /** | |
2220 | * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station | |
2221 | * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to | |
2222 | * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest | |
2223 | * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information | |
2224 | * | |
2225 | * Return: 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information | |
2226 | * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be | |
2227 | * considered undefined. | |
2228 | */ | |
2229 | int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, | |
2230 | struct station_info *sinfo); | |
2231 | #else | |
2232 | static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, | |
2233 | const u8 *mac_addr, | |
2234 | struct station_info *sinfo) | |
2235 | { | |
2236 | return -ENOENT; | |
2237 | } | |
2238 | #endif | |
2239 | ||
2240 | /** | |
2241 | * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags | |
2242 | * | |
2243 | * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits | |
2244 | * according to the nl80211 flags. | |
2245 | * | |
2246 | * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed | |
2247 | * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS | |
2248 | * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP | |
2249 | * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames | |
2250 | * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering | |
2251 | * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: deprecated, will unconditionally be refused | |
2252 | * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address | |
2253 | * @MONITOR_FLAG_SKIP_TX: do not pass locally transmitted frames | |
2254 | */ | |
2255 | enum monitor_flags { | |
2256 | MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED = BIT(__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID), | |
2257 | MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL = BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL), | |
2258 | MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL = BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL), | |
2259 | MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL = BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL), | |
2260 | MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS = BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS), | |
2261 | MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES = BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES), | |
2262 | MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE = BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE), | |
2263 | MONITOR_FLAG_SKIP_TX = BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_SKIP_TX), | |
2264 | }; | |
2265 | ||
2266 | /** | |
2267 | * enum mpath_info_flags - mesh path information flags | |
2268 | * | |
2269 | * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled | |
2270 | * in during get_station() or dump_station(). | |
2271 | * | |
2272 | * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled | |
2273 | * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled | |
2274 | * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled | |
2275 | * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled | |
2276 | * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled | |
2277 | * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled | |
2278 | * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled | |
2279 | * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled | |
2280 | * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled | |
2281 | */ | |
2282 | enum mpath_info_flags { | |
2283 | MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN = BIT(0), | |
2284 | MPATH_INFO_SN = BIT(1), | |
2285 | MPATH_INFO_METRIC = BIT(2), | |
2286 | MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME = BIT(3), | |
2287 | MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT = BIT(4), | |
2288 | MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES = BIT(5), | |
2289 | MPATH_INFO_FLAGS = BIT(6), | |
2290 | MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT = BIT(7), | |
2291 | MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE = BIT(8), | |
2292 | }; | |
2293 | ||
2294 | /** | |
2295 | * struct mpath_info - mesh path information | |
2296 | * | |
2297 | * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath(). | |
2298 | * | |
2299 | * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags | |
2300 | * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination | |
2301 | * @sn: target sequence number | |
2302 | * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path | |
2303 | * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs | |
2304 | * @flags: mesh path flags from &enum mesh_path_flags | |
2305 | * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs | |
2306 | * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries | |
2307 | * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps. | |
2308 | * This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths | |
2309 | * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that | |
2310 | * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot. | |
2311 | * @hop_count: hops to destination | |
2312 | * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination | |
2313 | */ | |
2314 | struct mpath_info { | |
2315 | u32 filled; | |
2316 | u32 frame_qlen; | |
2317 | u32 sn; | |
2318 | u32 metric; | |
2319 | u32 exptime; | |
2320 | u32 discovery_timeout; | |
2321 | u8 discovery_retries; | |
2322 | u8 flags; | |
2323 | u8 hop_count; | |
2324 | u32 path_change_count; | |
2325 | ||
2326 | int generation; | |
2327 | }; | |
2328 | ||
2329 | /** | |
2330 | * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters | |
2331 | * | |
2332 | * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode). | |
2333 | * | |
2334 | * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD | |
2335 | * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection | |
2336 | * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) | |
2337 | * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed | |
2338 | * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) | |
2339 | * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed | |
2340 | * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) | |
2341 | * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format | |
2342 | * (or NULL for no change) | |
2343 | * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates | |
2344 | * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations | |
2345 | * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) | |
2346 | * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode | |
2347 | * (u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change) | |
2348 | * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change) | |
2349 | * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change) | |
2350 | */ | |
2351 | struct bss_parameters { | |
2352 | int link_id; | |
2353 | int use_cts_prot; | |
2354 | int use_short_preamble; | |
2355 | int use_short_slot_time; | |
2356 | const u8 *basic_rates; | |
2357 | u8 basic_rates_len; | |
2358 | int ap_isolate; | |
2359 | int ht_opmode; | |
2360 | s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps; | |
2361 | }; | |
2362 | ||
2363 | /** | |
2364 | * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration | |
2365 | * | |
2366 | * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active. | |
2367 | * | |
2368 | * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used | |
2369 | * by the Mesh Peering Open message | |
2370 | * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units | |
2371 | * used by the Mesh Peering Open message | |
2372 | * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by | |
2373 | * the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering | |
2374 | * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this | |
2375 | * mesh interface | |
2376 | * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can | |
2377 | * be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh | |
2378 | * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA | |
2379 | * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection | |
2380 | * elements | |
2381 | * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we | |
2382 | * detect compatible mesh peers | |
2383 | * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to | |
2384 | * synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method | |
2385 | * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ | |
2386 | * that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target | |
2387 | * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds | |
2388 | * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on | |
2389 | * a path discovery in milliseconds | |
2390 | * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs | |
2391 | * receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the | |
2392 | * root to be valid. (TU = time unit) | |
2393 | * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during | |
2394 | * which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ | |
2395 | * element | |
2396 | * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during | |
2397 | * which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR | |
2398 | * element | |
2399 | * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that | |
2400 | * it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh | |
2401 | * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA | |
2402 | * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root | |
2403 | * announcements are transmitted | |
2404 | * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh | |
2405 | * station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is | |
2406 | * missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true | |
2407 | * only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but | |
2408 | * not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the | |
2409 | * same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec) | |
2410 | * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding | |
2411 | * entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity) | |
2412 | * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate | |
2413 | * station to establish a peer link | |
2414 | * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode | |
2415 | * | |
2416 | * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs | |
2417 | * receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to | |
2418 | * the root mesh STA to be valid. | |
2419 | * | |
2420 | * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive | |
2421 | * PREQs are transmitted. | |
2422 | * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs) | |
2423 | * during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing | |
2424 | * a PREQ element for root path confirmation. | |
2425 | * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial | |
2426 | * setting for new peer links. | |
2427 | * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake | |
2428 | * after transmitting its beacon. | |
2429 | * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established | |
2430 | * peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it | |
2431 | * from the STA's list of peers. Default is 30 minutes. | |
2432 | * @dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer: if set to true then this mesh STA | |
2433 | * will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server | |
2434 | * in the mesh formation field. | |
2435 | * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is | |
2436 | * connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info. If false, the | |
2437 | * value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths | |
2438 | * in the mesh path table | |
2439 | * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP | |
2440 | * for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might | |
2441 | * not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So | |
2442 | * if using this setting you will likely also want to disable | |
2443 | * dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top. | |
2444 | */ | |
2445 | struct mesh_config { | |
2446 | u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout; | |
2447 | u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout; | |
2448 | u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout; | |
2449 | u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks; | |
2450 | u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries; | |
2451 | u8 dot11MeshTTL; | |
2452 | u8 element_ttl; | |
2453 | bool auto_open_plinks; | |
2454 | u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor; | |
2455 | u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries; | |
2456 | u32 path_refresh_time; | |
2457 | u16 min_discovery_timeout; | |
2458 | u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout; | |
2459 | u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval; | |
2460 | u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval; | |
2461 | u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime; | |
2462 | u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode; | |
2463 | bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate; | |
2464 | bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer; | |
2465 | u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval; | |
2466 | bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol; | |
2467 | bool dot11MeshForwarding; | |
2468 | s32 rssi_threshold; | |
2469 | u16 ht_opmode; | |
2470 | u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout; | |
2471 | u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval; | |
2472 | u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval; | |
2473 | enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode; | |
2474 | u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration; | |
2475 | u32 plink_timeout; | |
2476 | bool dot11MeshNolearn; | |
2477 | }; | |
2478 | ||
2479 | /** | |
2480 | * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration | |
2481 | * @chandef: defines the channel to use | |
2482 | * @mesh_id: the mesh ID | |
2483 | * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes | |
2484 | * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use | |
2485 | * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use | |
2486 | * @path_metric: which metric to use | |
2487 | * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using | |
2488 | * @ie: vendor information elements (optional) | |
2489 | * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements | |
2490 | * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication | |
2491 | * @is_secure: this mesh uses security | |
2492 | * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions | |
2493 | * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use | |
2494 | * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use | |
2495 | * @mcast_rate: multicast rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a] | |
2496 | * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh | |
2497 | * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons | |
2498 | * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e. | |
2499 | * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required | |
2500 | * to operate on DFS channels. | |
2501 | * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control | |
2502 | * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. | |
2503 | * | |
2504 | * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created. | |
2505 | */ | |
2506 | struct mesh_setup { | |
2507 | struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; | |
2508 | const u8 *mesh_id; | |
2509 | u8 mesh_id_len; | |
2510 | u8 sync_method; | |
2511 | u8 path_sel_proto; | |
2512 | u8 path_metric; | |
2513 | u8 auth_id; | |
2514 | const u8 *ie; | |
2515 | u8 ie_len; | |
2516 | bool is_authenticated; | |
2517 | bool is_secure; | |
2518 | bool user_mpm; | |
2519 | u8 dtim_period; | |
2520 | u16 beacon_interval; | |
2521 | int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; | |
2522 | u32 basic_rates; | |
2523 | struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate; | |
2524 | bool userspace_handles_dfs; | |
2525 | bool control_port_over_nl80211; | |
2526 | }; | |
2527 | ||
2528 | /** | |
2529 | * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration | |
2530 | * @chandef: defines the channel to use | |
2531 | * | |
2532 | * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network | |
2533 | */ | |
2534 | struct ocb_setup { | |
2535 | struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; | |
2536 | }; | |
2537 | ||
2538 | /** | |
2539 | * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters | |
2540 | * @ac: AC identifier | |
2541 | * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled | |
2542 | * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range | |
2543 | * 1..32767] | |
2544 | * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range | |
2545 | * 1..32767] | |
2546 | * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255] | |
2547 | * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD | |
2548 | */ | |
2549 | struct ieee80211_txq_params { | |
2550 | enum nl80211_ac ac; | |
2551 | u16 txop; | |
2552 | u16 cwmin; | |
2553 | u16 cwmax; | |
2554 | u8 aifs; | |
2555 | int link_id; | |
2556 | }; | |
2557 | ||
2558 | /** | |
2559 | * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling | |
2560 | * | |
2561 | * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite | |
2562 | * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will | |
2563 | * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the | |
2564 | * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the | |
2565 | * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to | |
2566 | * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements | |
2567 | * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be | |
2568 | * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised | |
2569 | * in the wiphy structure. | |
2570 | * | |
2571 | * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because | |
2572 | * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not | |
2573 | * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist. | |
2574 | * | |
2575 | * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of | |
2576 | * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the | |
2577 | * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available | |
2578 | * to userspace. | |
2579 | */ | |
2580 | ||
2581 | /** | |
2582 | * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description | |
2583 | * @ssid: the SSID | |
2584 | * @ssid_len: length of the ssid | |
2585 | */ | |
2586 | struct cfg80211_ssid { | |
2587 | u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; | |
2588 | u8 ssid_len; | |
2589 | }; | |
2590 | ||
2591 | /** | |
2592 | * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan | |
2593 | * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the | |
2594 | * wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this | |
2595 | * information is not available, this field is left zero. | |
2596 | * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set. | |
2597 | * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason, | |
2598 | * userspace will be notified of that | |
2599 | */ | |
2600 | struct cfg80211_scan_info { | |
2601 | u64 scan_start_tsf; | |
2602 | u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | |
2603 | bool aborted; | |
2604 | }; | |
2605 | ||
2606 | /** | |
2607 | * struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params - relevant for 6 GHz only | |
2608 | * | |
2609 | * @short_ssid: short ssid to scan for | |
2610 | * @bssid: bssid to scan for | |
2611 | * @channel_idx: idx of the channel in the channel array in the scan request | |
2612 | * which the above info is relevant to | |
2613 | * @unsolicited_probe: the AP transmits unsolicited probe response every 20 TU | |
2614 | * @short_ssid_valid: @short_ssid is valid and can be used | |
2615 | * @psc_no_listen: when set, and the channel is a PSC channel, no need to wait | |
2616 | * 20 TUs before starting to send probe requests. | |
2617 | * @psd_20: The AP's 20 MHz PSD value. | |
2618 | */ | |
2619 | struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params { | |
2620 | u32 short_ssid; | |
2621 | u32 channel_idx; | |
2622 | u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; | |
2623 | bool unsolicited_probe; | |
2624 | bool short_ssid_valid; | |
2625 | bool psc_no_listen; | |
2626 | s8 psd_20; | |
2627 | }; | |
2628 | ||
2629 | /** | |
2630 | * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description | |
2631 | * | |
2632 | * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only) | |
2633 | * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs | |
2634 | * @channels: channels to scan on. | |
2635 | * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan | |
2636 | * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL | |
2637 | * @ie_len: length of ie in octets | |
2638 | * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If | |
2639 | * %duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and | |
2640 | * the actual dwell time may be shorter. | |
2641 | * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the | |
2642 | * %duration field. | |
2643 | * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags | |
2644 | * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band | |
2645 | * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for | |
2646 | * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started | |
2647 | * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for | |
2648 | * @info: (internal) information about completed scan | |
2649 | * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted | |
2650 | * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band | |
2651 | * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation | |
2652 | * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that | |
2653 | * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should | |
2654 | * be taken from the @mac_addr | |
2655 | * @scan_6ghz: relevant for split scan request only, | |
2656 | * true if this is the second scan request | |
2657 | * @n_6ghz_params: number of 6 GHz params | |
2658 | * @scan_6ghz_params: 6 GHz params | |
2659 | * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID) | |
2660 | * @tsf_report_link_id: for MLO, indicates the link ID of the BSS that should be | |
2661 | * used for TSF reporting. Can be set to -1 to indicate no preference. | |
2662 | */ | |
2663 | struct cfg80211_scan_request { | |
2664 | struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids; | |
2665 | int n_ssids; | |
2666 | u32 n_channels; | |
2667 | const u8 *ie; | |
2668 | size_t ie_len; | |
2669 | u16 duration; | |
2670 | bool duration_mandatory; | |
2671 | u32 flags; | |
2672 | ||
2673 | u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; | |
2674 | ||
2675 | struct wireless_dev *wdev; | |
2676 | ||
2677 | u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | |
2678 | u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | |
2679 | u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | |
2680 | ||
2681 | /* internal */ | |
2682 | struct wiphy *wiphy; | |
2683 | unsigned long scan_start; | |
2684 | struct cfg80211_scan_info info; | |
2685 | bool notified; | |
2686 | bool no_cck; | |
2687 | bool scan_6ghz; | |
2688 | u32 n_6ghz_params; | |
2689 | struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params *scan_6ghz_params; | |
2690 | s8 tsf_report_link_id; | |
2691 | ||
2692 | /* keep last */ | |
2693 | struct ieee80211_channel *channels[] __counted_by(n_channels); | |
2694 | }; | |
2695 | ||
2696 | static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask) | |
2697 | { | |
2698 | int i; | |
2699 | ||
2700 | get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN); | |
2701 | for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) { | |
2702 | buf[i] &= ~mask[i]; | |
2703 | buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i]; | |
2704 | } | |
2705 | } | |
2706 | ||
2707 | /** | |
2708 | * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match | |
2709 | * | |
2710 | * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match | |
2711 | * or no match (RSSI only) | |
2712 | * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match | |
2713 | * or no match (RSSI only) | |
2714 | * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm) | |
2715 | */ | |
2716 | struct cfg80211_match_set { | |
2717 | struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; | |
2718 | u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; | |
2719 | s32 rssi_thold; | |
2720 | }; | |
2721 | ||
2722 | /** | |
2723 | * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan | |
2724 | * | |
2725 | * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds. | |
2726 | * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means | |
2727 | * infinite loop. | |
2728 | * The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero, | |
2729 | * all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations. | |
2730 | */ | |
2731 | struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan { | |
2732 | u32 interval; | |
2733 | u32 iterations; | |
2734 | }; | |
2735 | ||
2736 | /** | |
2737 | * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment. | |
2738 | * | |
2739 | * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment. | |
2740 | * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment. | |
2741 | */ | |
2742 | struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust { | |
2743 | enum nl80211_band band; | |
2744 | s8 delta; | |
2745 | }; | |
2746 | ||
2747 | /** | |
2748 | * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description | |
2749 | * | |
2750 | * @reqid: identifies this request. | |
2751 | * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans) | |
2752 | * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs | |
2753 | * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan | |
2754 | * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL | |
2755 | * @ie_len: length of ie in octets | |
2756 | * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags | |
2757 | * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result | |
2758 | * entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host | |
2759 | * (others are filtered out). | |
2760 | * If omitted, all results are passed. | |
2761 | * @n_match_sets: number of match sets | |
2762 | * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request | |
2763 | * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for | |
2764 | * @dev: the interface | |
2765 | * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan | |
2766 | * @channels: channels to scan | |
2767 | * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this | |
2768 | * contains the minimum over all matchsets | |
2769 | * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation | |
2770 | * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that | |
2771 | * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should | |
2772 | * be taken from the @mac_addr | |
2773 | * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest | |
2774 | * index must be executed first. | |
2775 | * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1. | |
2776 | * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct | |
2777 | * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request | |
2778 | * owned by a particular socket) | |
2779 | * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed | |
2780 | * @list: for keeping list of requests. | |
2781 | * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan | |
2782 | * cycle. The driver may ignore this parameter and start | |
2783 | * immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not | |
2784 | * supported. | |
2785 | * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not. | |
2786 | * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result | |
2787 | * reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined | |
2788 | * to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS. | |
2789 | * The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state. | |
2790 | * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong | |
2791 | * to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported | |
2792 | * using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that | |
2793 | * belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative | |
2794 | * comparisons. | |
2795 | */ | |
2796 | struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request { | |
2797 | u64 reqid; | |
2798 | struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids; | |
2799 | int n_ssids; | |
2800 | u32 n_channels; | |
2801 | const u8 *ie; | |
2802 | size_t ie_len; | |
2803 | u32 flags; | |
2804 | struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets; | |
2805 | int n_match_sets; | |
2806 | s32 min_rssi_thold; | |
2807 | u32 delay; | |
2808 | struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans; | |
2809 | int n_scan_plans; | |
2810 | ||
2811 | u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | |
2812 | u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | |
2813 | ||
2814 | bool relative_rssi_set; | |
2815 | s8 relative_rssi; | |
2816 | struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust; | |
2817 | ||
2818 | /* internal */ | |
2819 | struct wiphy *wiphy; | |
2820 | struct net_device *dev; | |
2821 | unsigned long scan_start; | |
2822 | bool report_results; | |
2823 | struct rcu_head rcu_head; | |
2824 | u32 owner_nlportid; | |
2825 | bool nl_owner_dead; | |
2826 | struct list_head list; | |
2827 | ||
2828 | /* keep last */ | |
2829 | struct ieee80211_channel *channels[] __counted_by(n_channels); | |
2830 | }; | |
2831 | ||
2832 | /** | |
2833 | * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type | |
2834 | * | |
2835 | * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available | |
2836 | * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm) | |
2837 | * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100 | |
2838 | */ | |
2839 | enum cfg80211_signal_type { | |
2840 | CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE, | |
2841 | CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, | |
2842 | CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC, | |
2843 | }; | |
2844 | ||
2845 | /** | |
2846 | * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data | |
2847 | * @chan: channel the frame was received on | |
2848 | * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's | |
2849 | * signal type | |
2850 | * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was | |
2851 | * received; should match the time when the frame was actually | |
2852 | * received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was | |
2853 | * buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms. | |
2854 | * If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of | |
2855 | * ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate. | |
2856 | * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the | |
2857 | * timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified | |
2858 | * by %parent_bssid. | |
2859 | * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to | |
2860 | * the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received. | |
2861 | * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal. | |
2862 | * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm. | |
2863 | * @restrict_use: restrict usage, if not set, assume @use_for is | |
2864 | * %NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL. | |
2865 | * @use_for: bitmap of possible usage for this BSS, see | |
2866 | * &enum nl80211_bss_use_for | |
2867 | * @cannot_use_reasons: the reasons (bitmap) for not being able to connect, | |
2868 | * if @restrict_use is set and @use_for is zero (empty); may be 0 for | |
2869 | * unspecified reasons; see &enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons | |
2870 | * @drv_data: Data to be passed through to @inform_bss | |
2871 | */ | |
2872 | struct cfg80211_inform_bss { | |
2873 | struct ieee80211_channel *chan; | |
2874 | s32 signal; | |
2875 | u64 boottime_ns; | |
2876 | u64 parent_tsf; | |
2877 | u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | |
2878 | u8 chains; | |
2879 | s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; | |
2880 | ||
2881 | u8 restrict_use:1, use_for:7; | |
2882 | u8 cannot_use_reasons; | |
2883 | ||
2884 | void *drv_data; | |
2885 | }; | |
2886 | ||
2887 | /** | |
2888 | * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data | |
2889 | * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs | |
2890 | * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing | |
2891 | * @len: length of the IEs | |
2892 | * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon | |
2893 | * @data: IE data | |
2894 | */ | |
2895 | struct cfg80211_bss_ies { | |
2896 | u64 tsf; | |
2897 | struct rcu_head rcu_head; | |
2898 | int len; | |
2899 | bool from_beacon; | |
2900 | u8 data[]; | |
2901 | }; | |
2902 | ||
2903 | /** | |
2904 | * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description | |
2905 | * | |
2906 | * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network) | |
2907 | * for use in scan results and similar. | |
2908 | * | |
2909 | * @channel: channel this BSS is on | |
2910 | * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS | |
2911 | * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame | |
2912 | * @capability: the capability field in host byte order | |
2913 | * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these | |
2914 | * are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or | |
2915 | * proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been | |
2916 | * received. It is always non-%NULL. | |
2917 | * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame | |
2918 | * (implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't | |
2919 | * own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the | |
2920 | * @hidden_beacon_bss struct) | |
2921 | * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame | |
2922 | * @proberesp_ecsa_stuck: ECSA element is stuck in the Probe Response frame, | |
2923 | * cannot rely on it having valid data | |
2924 | * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from | |
2925 | * a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct | |
2926 | * that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and | |
2927 | * points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case. | |
2928 | * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a | |
2929 | * non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support) | |
2930 | * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one | |
2931 | * (multi-BSSID support) | |
2932 | * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type) | |
2933 | * @ts_boottime: timestamp of the last BSS update in nanoseconds since boot | |
2934 | * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal. | |
2935 | * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm. | |
2936 | * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set | |
2937 | * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set | |
2938 | * @use_for: bitmap of possible usage for this BSS, see | |
2939 | * &enum nl80211_bss_use_for | |
2940 | * @cannot_use_reasons: the reasons (bitmap) for not being able to connect, | |
2941 | * if @restrict_use is set and @use_for is zero (empty); may be 0 for | |
2942 | * unspecified reasons; see &enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons | |
2943 | * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes | |
2944 | */ | |
2945 | struct cfg80211_bss { | |
2946 | struct ieee80211_channel *channel; | |
2947 | ||
2948 | const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies; | |
2949 | const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies; | |
2950 | const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies; | |
2951 | ||
2952 | struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss; | |
2953 | struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss; | |
2954 | struct list_head nontrans_list; | |
2955 | ||
2956 | s32 signal; | |
2957 | ||
2958 | u64 ts_boottime; | |
2959 | ||
2960 | u16 beacon_interval; | |
2961 | u16 capability; | |
2962 | ||
2963 | u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; | |
2964 | u8 chains; | |
2965 | s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; | |
2966 | ||
2967 | u8 proberesp_ecsa_stuck:1; | |
2968 | ||
2969 | u8 bssid_index; | |
2970 | u8 max_bssid_indicator; | |
2971 | ||
2972 | u8 use_for; | |
2973 | u8 cannot_use_reasons; | |
2974 | ||
2975 | u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); | |
2976 | }; | |
2977 | ||
2978 | /** | |
2979 | * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID | |
2980 | * @bss: the bss to search | |
2981 | * @id: the element ID | |
2982 | * | |
2983 | * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so | |
2984 | * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function. | |
2985 | * Return: %NULL if not found. | |
2986 | */ | |
2987 | const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id); | |
2988 | ||
2989 | /** | |
2990 | * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID | |
2991 | * @bss: the bss to search | |
2992 | * @id: the element ID | |
2993 | * | |
2994 | * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so | |
2995 | * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function. | |
2996 | * Return: %NULL if not found. | |
2997 | */ | |
2998 | static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id) | |
2999 | { | |
3000 | return (const void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id); | |
3001 | } | |
3002 | ||
3003 | ||
3004 | /** | |
3005 | * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data | |
3006 | * | |
3007 | * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 | |
3008 | * authentication. | |
3009 | * | |
3010 | * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference | |
3011 | * to it if it needs to keep it. | |
3012 | * @supported_selectors: List of selectors that should be assumed to be | |
3013 | * supported by the station. | |
3014 | * SAE_H2E must be assumed supported if set to %NULL. | |
3015 | * @supported_selectors_len: Length of supported_selectors in octets. | |
3016 | * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) | |
3017 | * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL | |
3018 | * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets | |
3019 | * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication | |
3020 | * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication | |
3021 | * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication | |
3022 | * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains | |
3023 | * the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the | |
3024 | * Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication | |
3025 | * transaction sequence number field. | |
3026 | * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets | |
3027 | * @link_id: if >= 0, indicates authentication should be done as an MLD, | |
3028 | * the interface address is included as the MLD address and the | |
3029 | * necessary link (with the given link_id) will be created (and | |
3030 | * given an MLD address) by the driver | |
3031 | * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of authentication request with | |
3032 | * an AP MLD, valid iff @link_id >= 0 | |
3033 | */ | |
3034 | struct cfg80211_auth_request { | |
3035 | struct cfg80211_bss *bss; | |
3036 | const u8 *ie; | |
3037 | size_t ie_len; | |
3038 | const u8 *supported_selectors; | |
3039 | u8 supported_selectors_len; | |
3040 | enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; | |
3041 | const u8 *key; | |
3042 | u8 key_len; | |
3043 | s8 key_idx; | |
3044 | const u8 *auth_data; | |
3045 | size_t auth_data_len; | |
3046 | s8 link_id; | |
3047 | const u8 *ap_mld_addr; | |
3048 | }; | |
3049 | ||
3050 | /** | |
3051 | * struct cfg80211_assoc_link - per-link information for MLO association | |
3052 | * @bss: the BSS pointer, see also &struct cfg80211_assoc_request::bss; | |
3053 | * if this is %NULL for a link, that link is not requested | |
3054 | * @elems: extra elements for the per-STA profile for this link | |
3055 | * @elems_len: length of the elements | |
3056 | * @disabled: If set this link should be included during association etc. but it | |
3057 | * should not be used until enabled by the AP MLD. | |
3058 | * @error: per-link error code, must be <= 0. If there is an error, then the | |
3059 | * operation as a whole must fail. | |
3060 | */ | |
3061 | struct cfg80211_assoc_link { | |
3062 | struct cfg80211_bss *bss; | |
3063 | const u8 *elems; | |
3064 | size_t elems_len; | |
3065 | bool disabled; | |
3066 | int error; | |
3067 | }; | |
3068 | ||
3069 | /** | |
3070 | * struct cfg80211_ml_reconf_req - MLO link reconfiguration request | |
3071 | * @add_links: data for links to add, see &struct cfg80211_assoc_link | |
3072 | * @rem_links: bitmap of links to remove | |
3073 | * @ext_mld_capa_ops: extended MLD capabilities and operations set by | |
3074 | * userspace for the ML reconfiguration action frame | |
3075 | */ | |
3076 | struct cfg80211_ml_reconf_req { | |
3077 | struct cfg80211_assoc_link add_links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; | |
3078 | u16 rem_links; | |
3079 | u16 ext_mld_capa_ops; | |
3080 | }; | |
3081 | ||
3082 | /** | |
3083 | * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association. | |
3084 | * | |
3085 | * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT: Disable HT (802.11n) | |
3086 | * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT: Disable VHT | |
3087 | * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association | |
3088 | * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external | |
3089 | * authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to | |
3090 | * userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect() | |
3091 | * request (connect callback). | |
3092 | * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE: Disable HE | |
3093 | * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT: Disable EHT | |
3094 | * @CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT: Userspace indicates support for handling MLD links. | |
3095 | * Drivers shall disable MLO features for the current association if this | |
3096 | * flag is not set. | |
3097 | * @ASSOC_REQ_SPP_AMSDU: SPP A-MSDUs will be used on this connection (if any) | |
3098 | */ | |
3099 | enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags { | |
3100 | ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT = BIT(0), | |
3101 | ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT = BIT(1), | |
3102 | ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM = BIT(2), | |
3103 | CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = BIT(3), | |
3104 | ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE = BIT(4), | |
3105 | ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT = BIT(5), | |
3106 | CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT = BIT(6), | |
3107 | ASSOC_REQ_SPP_AMSDU = BIT(7), | |
3108 | }; | |
3109 | ||
3110 | /** | |
3111 | * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data | |
3112 | * | |
3113 | * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 | |
3114 | * (re)association. | |
3115 | * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is | |
3116 | * given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc() | |
3117 | * or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new | |
3118 | * association requests while already associating must be rejected. | |
3119 | * This also applies to the @links.bss parameter, which is used instead | |
3120 | * of this one (it is %NULL) for MLO associations. | |
3121 | * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL | |
3122 | * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets | |
3123 | * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association | |
3124 | * @crypto: crypto settings | |
3125 | * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used | |
3126 | * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request | |
3127 | * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to | |
3128 | * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is | |
3129 | * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request | |
3130 | * frame. | |
3131 | * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags | |
3132 | * @supported_selectors: supported BSS selectors in IEEE 802.11 format | |
3133 | * (or %NULL for no change). | |
3134 | * If %NULL, then support for SAE_H2E should be assumed. | |
3135 | * @supported_selectors_len: number of supported BSS selectors | |
3136 | * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask | |
3137 | * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. | |
3138 | * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. | |
3139 | * @vht_capa: VHT capability override | |
3140 | * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use | |
3141 | * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or | |
3142 | * %NULL if FILS is not used. | |
3143 | * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets | |
3144 | * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association | |
3145 | * Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts | |
3146 | * with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce. | |
3147 | * @s1g_capa: S1G capability override | |
3148 | * @s1g_capa_mask: S1G capability override mask | |
3149 | * @links: per-link information for MLO connections | |
3150 | * @link_id: >= 0 for MLO connections, where links are given, and indicates | |
3151 | * the link on which the association request should be sent | |
3152 | * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of MLO association request, | |
3153 | * valid iff @link_id >= 0 | |
3154 | * @ext_mld_capa_ops: extended MLD capabilities and operations set by | |
3155 | * userspace for the association | |
3156 | */ | |
3157 | struct cfg80211_assoc_request { | |
3158 | struct cfg80211_bss *bss; | |
3159 | const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid; | |
3160 | size_t ie_len; | |
3161 | struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; | |
3162 | bool use_mfp; | |
3163 | u32 flags; | |
3164 | const u8 *supported_selectors; | |
3165 | u8 supported_selectors_len; | |
3166 | struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; | |
3167 | struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; | |
3168 | struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask; | |
3169 | const u8 *fils_kek; | |
3170 | size_t fils_kek_len; | |
3171 | const u8 *fils_nonces; | |
3172 | struct ieee80211_s1g_cap s1g_capa, s1g_capa_mask; | |
3173 | struct cfg80211_assoc_link links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; | |
3174 | const u8 *ap_mld_addr; | |
3175 | s8 link_id; | |
3176 | u16 ext_mld_capa_ops; | |
3177 | }; | |
3178 | ||
3179 | /** | |
3180 | * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data | |
3181 | * | |
3182 | * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 | |
3183 | * deauthentication. | |
3184 | * | |
3185 | * @bssid: the BSSID or AP MLD address to deauthenticate from | |
3186 | * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL | |
3187 | * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets | |
3188 | * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication | |
3189 | * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and | |
3190 | * do not set a deauth frame | |
3191 | */ | |
3192 | struct cfg80211_deauth_request { | |
3193 | const u8 *bssid; | |
3194 | const u8 *ie; | |
3195 | size_t ie_len; | |
3196 | u16 reason_code; | |
3197 | bool local_state_change; | |
3198 | }; | |
3199 | ||
3200 | /** | |
3201 | * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data | |
3202 | * | |
3203 | * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 | |
3204 | * disassociation. | |
3205 | * | |
3206 | * @ap_addr: the BSSID or AP MLD address to disassociate from | |
3207 | * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL | |
3208 | * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets | |
3209 | * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation | |
3210 | * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no | |
3211 | * Disassociation frame is to be transmitted. | |
3212 | */ | |
3213 | struct cfg80211_disassoc_request { | |
3214 | const u8 *ap_addr; | |
3215 | const u8 *ie; | |
3216 | size_t ie_len; | |
3217 | u16 reason_code; | |
3218 | bool local_state_change; | |
3219 | }; | |
3220 | ||
3221 | /** | |
3222 | * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters | |
3223 | * | |
3224 | * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss() | |
3225 | * method. | |
3226 | * | |
3227 | * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null. | |
3228 | * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero. | |
3229 | * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not | |
3230 | * search for IBSSs with a different BSSID. | |
3231 | * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found | |
3232 | * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for | |
3233 | * IBSSs to join on other channels. | |
3234 | * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon | |
3235 | * @ie_len: length of that | |
3236 | * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use | |
3237 | * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured | |
3238 | * after joining | |
3239 | * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., | |
3240 | * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is | |
3241 | * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by | |
3242 | * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default. | |
3243 | * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control | |
3244 | * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. | |
3245 | * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e. | |
3246 | * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required | |
3247 | * to operate on DFS channels. | |
3248 | * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS | |
3249 | * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled) | |
3250 | * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask | |
3251 | * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. | |
3252 | * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. | |
3253 | * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of | |
3254 | * CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys | |
3255 | * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key | |
3256 | */ | |
3257 | struct cfg80211_ibss_params { | |
3258 | const u8 *ssid; | |
3259 | const u8 *bssid; | |
3260 | struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; | |
3261 | const u8 *ie; | |
3262 | u8 ssid_len, ie_len; | |
3263 | u16 beacon_interval; | |
3264 | u32 basic_rates; | |
3265 | bool channel_fixed; | |
3266 | bool privacy; | |
3267 | bool control_port; | |
3268 | bool control_port_over_nl80211; | |
3269 | bool userspace_handles_dfs; | |
3270 | int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; | |
3271 | struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; | |
3272 | struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; | |
3273 | struct key_params *wep_keys; | |
3274 | int wep_tx_key; | |
3275 | }; | |
3276 | ||
3277 | /** | |
3278 | * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection. | |
3279 | * | |
3280 | * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour. | |
3281 | * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour. | |
3282 | * @param.band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF. | |
3283 | * @param.adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST. | |
3284 | */ | |
3285 | struct cfg80211_bss_selection { | |
3286 | enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour; | |
3287 | union { | |
3288 | enum nl80211_band band_pref; | |
3289 | struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust; | |
3290 | } param; | |
3291 | }; | |
3292 | ||
3293 | /** | |
3294 | * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters | |
3295 | * | |
3296 | * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 | |
3297 | * authentication and association. | |
3298 | * | |
3299 | * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based | |
3300 | * on scan results) | |
3301 | * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or | |
3302 | * %NULL if not specified | |
3303 | * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan | |
3304 | * results) | |
3305 | * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or | |
3306 | * %NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is | |
3307 | * allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS | |
3308 | * to use. | |
3309 | * @ssid: SSID | |
3310 | * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets | |
3311 | * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) | |
3312 | * @ie: IEs for association request | |
3313 | * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets | |
3314 | * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used | |
3315 | * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used | |
3316 | * @crypto: crypto settings | |
3317 | * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication | |
3318 | * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication | |
3319 | * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication | |
3320 | * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags | |
3321 | * @bg_scan_period: Background scan period in seconds | |
3322 | * or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used. | |
3323 | * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask | |
3324 | * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. | |
3325 | * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. | |
3326 | * @vht_capa: VHT Capability overrides | |
3327 | * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used. | |
3328 | * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG | |
3329 | * networks. | |
3330 | * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection. | |
3331 | * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used | |
3332 | * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request | |
3333 | * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to | |
3334 | * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is | |
3335 | * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request | |
3336 | * frame. | |
3337 | * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the | |
3338 | * NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped | |
3339 | * data IE. | |
3340 | * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets. | |
3341 | * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or | |
3342 | * %NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and | |
3343 | * is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE. | |
3344 | * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets. | |
3345 | * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP | |
3346 | * messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE. | |
3347 | * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional | |
3348 | * keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified. | |
3349 | * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets. | |
3350 | * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver | |
3351 | * offload of 4-way handshake. | |
3352 | * @edmg: define the EDMG channels. | |
3353 | * This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver | |
3354 | * to choose from, based on BSS configuration. | |
3355 | */ | |
3356 | struct cfg80211_connect_params { | |
3357 | struct ieee80211_channel *channel; | |
3358 | struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint; | |
3359 | const u8 *bssid; | |
3360 | const u8 *bssid_hint; | |
3361 | const u8 *ssid; | |
3362 | size_t ssid_len; | |
3363 | enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; | |
3364 | const u8 *ie; | |
3365 | size_t ie_len; | |
3366 | bool privacy; | |
3367 | enum nl80211_mfp mfp; | |
3368 | struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; | |
3369 | const u8 *key; | |
3370 | u8 key_len, key_idx; | |
3371 | u32 flags; | |
3372 | int bg_scan_period; | |
3373 | struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; | |
3374 | struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; | |
3375 | struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa; | |
3376 | struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask; | |
3377 | bool pbss; | |
3378 | struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select; | |
3379 | const u8 *prev_bssid; | |
3380 | const u8 *fils_erp_username; | |
3381 | size_t fils_erp_username_len; | |
3382 | const u8 *fils_erp_realm; | |
3383 | size_t fils_erp_realm_len; | |
3384 | u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num; | |
3385 | const u8 *fils_erp_rrk; | |
3386 | size_t fils_erp_rrk_len; | |
3387 | bool want_1x; | |
3388 | struct ieee80211_edmg edmg; | |
3389 | }; | |
3390 | ||
3391 | /** | |
3392 | * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated | |
3393 | * | |
3394 | * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that | |
3395 | * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call. | |
3396 | * | |
3397 | * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated | |
3398 | * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm, | |
3399 | * username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated | |
3400 | * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated | |
3401 | */ | |
3402 | enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed { | |
3403 | UPDATE_ASSOC_IES = BIT(0), | |
3404 | UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO = BIT(1), | |
3405 | UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE = BIT(2), | |
3406 | }; | |
3407 | ||
3408 | /** | |
3409 | * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values | |
3410 | * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed | |
3411 | * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed | |
3412 | * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed | |
3413 | * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed | |
3414 | * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed | |
3415 | * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled | |
3416 | * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed | |
3417 | * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed | |
3418 | * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum | |
3419 | */ | |
3420 | enum wiphy_params_flags { | |
3421 | WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT = BIT(0), | |
3422 | WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG = BIT(1), | |
3423 | WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD = BIT(2), | |
3424 | WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD = BIT(3), | |
3425 | WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS = BIT(4), | |
3426 | WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK = BIT(5), | |
3427 | WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT = BIT(6), | |
3428 | WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT = BIT(7), | |
3429 | WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM = BIT(8), | |
3430 | }; | |
3431 | ||
3432 | #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT 256 | |
3433 | ||
3434 | /* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */ | |
3435 | #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L 5000 | |
3436 | #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H 12000 | |
3437 | ||
3438 | /* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */ | |
3439 | #define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD 24000 | |
3440 | ||
3441 | /** | |
3442 | * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association | |
3443 | * | |
3444 | * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA | |
3445 | * caching. | |
3446 | * | |
3447 | * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL). | |
3448 | * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA. | |
3449 | * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key | |
3450 | * derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL. | |
3451 | * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on | |
3452 | * the hash algorithm used to generate this. | |
3453 | * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS | |
3454 | * cache identifier (may be %NULL). | |
3455 | * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets. | |
3456 | * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the | |
3457 | * scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be | |
3458 | * %NULL). | |
3459 | * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds | |
3460 | * (dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified. | |
3461 | * The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after | |
3462 | * expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on | |
3463 | * expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK | |
3464 | * used for it expires. | |
3465 | * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of | |
3466 | * PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified. | |
3467 | * Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using | |
3468 | * this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this | |
3469 | * threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires. | |
3470 | */ | |
3471 | struct cfg80211_pmksa { | |
3472 | const u8 *bssid; | |
3473 | const u8 *pmkid; | |
3474 | const u8 *pmk; | |
3475 | size_t pmk_len; | |
3476 | const u8 *ssid; | |
3477 | size_t ssid_len; | |
3478 | const u8 *cache_id; | |
3479 | u32 pmk_lifetime; | |
3480 | u8 pmk_reauth_threshold; | |
3481 | }; | |
3482 | ||
3483 | /** | |
3484 | * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern | |
3485 | * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes, | |
3486 | * one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211 | |
3487 | * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1 | |
3488 | * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes) | |
3489 | * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes) | |
3490 | * | |
3491 | * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of | |
3492 | * memory, free @mask only! | |
3493 | */ | |
3494 | struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern { | |
3495 | const u8 *mask, *pattern; | |
3496 | int pattern_len; | |
3497 | int pkt_offset; | |
3498 | }; | |
3499 | ||
3500 | /** | |
3501 | * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters | |
3502 | * | |
3503 | * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation | |
3504 | * @src: source IP address | |
3505 | * @dst: destination IP address | |
3506 | * @dst_mac: destination MAC address | |
3507 | * @src_port: source port | |
3508 | * @dst_port: destination port | |
3509 | * @payload_len: data payload length | |
3510 | * @payload: data payload buffer | |
3511 | * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration | |
3512 | * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets | |
3513 | * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length | |
3514 | * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data | |
3515 | * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask | |
3516 | * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer | |
3517 | * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration | |
3518 | */ | |
3519 | struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp { | |
3520 | struct socket *sock; | |
3521 | __be32 src, dst; | |
3522 | u16 src_port, dst_port; | |
3523 | u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN]; | |
3524 | int payload_len; | |
3525 | const u8 *payload; | |
3526 | struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq; | |
3527 | u32 data_interval; | |
3528 | u32 wake_len; | |
3529 | const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask; | |
3530 | u32 tokens_size; | |
3531 | /* must be last, variable member */ | |
3532 | struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok; | |
3533 | }; | |
3534 | ||
3535 | /** | |
3536 | * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info | |
3537 | * | |
3538 | * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device. | |
3539 | * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues | |
3540 | * operating as normal during suspend | |
3541 | * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected | |
3542 | * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet | |
3543 | * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern | |
3544 | * @n_patterns: number of patterns | |
3545 | * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure | |
3546 | * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet | |
3547 | * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake | |
3548 | * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released | |
3549 | * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h. | |
3550 | * NULL if not configured. | |
3551 | * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake. | |
3552 | */ | |
3553 | struct cfg80211_wowlan { | |
3554 | bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure, | |
3555 | eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake, | |
3556 | rfkill_release; | |
3557 | struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns; | |
3558 | struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp; | |
3559 | int n_patterns; | |
3560 | struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config; | |
3561 | }; | |
3562 | ||
3563 | /** | |
3564 | * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters | |
3565 | * | |
3566 | * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device. | |
3567 | * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs. | |
3568 | * @condition: condition for packet coalescence. | |
3569 | * see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition. | |
3570 | * @patterns: array of packet patterns | |
3571 | * @n_patterns: number of patterns | |
3572 | */ | |
3573 | struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules { | |
3574 | int delay; | |
3575 | enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition; | |
3576 | struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns; | |
3577 | int n_patterns; | |
3578 | }; | |
3579 | ||
3580 | /** | |
3581 | * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings | |
3582 | * | |
3583 | * This structure defines coalescing settings. | |
3584 | * @rules: array of coalesce rules | |
3585 | * @n_rules: number of rules | |
3586 | */ | |
3587 | struct cfg80211_coalesce { | |
3588 | int n_rules; | |
3589 | struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules rules[] __counted_by(n_rules); | |
3590 | }; | |
3591 | ||
3592 | /** | |
3593 | * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match | |
3594 | * | |
3595 | * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up | |
3596 | * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred. This | |
3597 | * value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels. | |
3598 | * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match | |
3599 | * occurred (in MHz) | |
3600 | */ | |
3601 | struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match { | |
3602 | struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; | |
3603 | int n_channels; | |
3604 | u32 channels[] __counted_by(n_channels); | |
3605 | }; | |
3606 | ||
3607 | /** | |
3608 | * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information | |
3609 | * | |
3610 | * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in | |
3611 | * @matches. This value may be zero if the driver can't provide | |
3612 | * match information. | |
3613 | * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about | |
3614 | * the matches that triggered the wake up. | |
3615 | */ | |
3616 | struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info { | |
3617 | int n_matches; | |
3618 | struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[] __counted_by(n_matches); | |
3619 | }; | |
3620 | ||
3621 | /** | |
3622 | * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report | |
3623 | * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected | |
3624 | * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet | |
3625 | * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure | |
3626 | * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet | |
3627 | * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake | |
3628 | * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released | |
3629 | * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern | |
3630 | * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data | |
3631 | * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length | |
3632 | * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any. | |
3633 | * @packet_80211: For pattern match, magic packet and other data | |
3634 | * frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for | |
3635 | * disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which | |
3636 | * it is. | |
3637 | * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received | |
3638 | * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish | |
3639 | * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens | |
3640 | * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect | |
3641 | * @unprot_deauth_disassoc: woke up due to unprotected deauth or | |
3642 | * disassoc frame (in MFP). | |
3643 | */ | |
3644 | struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup { | |
3645 | bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure, | |
3646 | eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake, | |
3647 | rfkill_release, packet_80211, | |
3648 | tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens, | |
3649 | unprot_deauth_disassoc; | |
3650 | s32 pattern_idx; | |
3651 | u32 packet_present_len, packet_len; | |
3652 | const void *packet; | |
3653 | struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect; | |
3654 | }; | |
3655 | ||
3656 | /** | |
3657 | * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data | |
3658 | * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes) | |
3659 | * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes) | |
3660 | * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes) | |
3661 | * @kek_len: length of kek | |
3662 | * @kck_len: length of kck | |
3663 | * @akm: akm (oui, id) | |
3664 | */ | |
3665 | struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data { | |
3666 | const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr; | |
3667 | u32 akm; | |
3668 | u8 kek_len, kck_len; | |
3669 | }; | |
3670 | ||
3671 | /** | |
3672 | * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information | |
3673 | * | |
3674 | * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE | |
3675 | * | |
3676 | * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value | |
3677 | * @ie: Fast Transition IEs | |
3678 | * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets | |
3679 | */ | |
3680 | struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params { | |
3681 | u16 md; | |
3682 | const u8 *ie; | |
3683 | size_t ie_len; | |
3684 | }; | |
3685 | ||
3686 | /** | |
3687 | * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters | |
3688 | * | |
3689 | * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame | |
3690 | * | |
3691 | * @chan: channel to use | |
3692 | * @offchan: indicates whether off channel operation is required | |
3693 | * @wait: duration for ROC | |
3694 | * @buf: buffer to transmit | |
3695 | * @len: buffer length | |
3696 | * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame | |
3697 | * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack | |
3698 | * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array | |
3699 | * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame | |
3700 | * @link_id: for MLO, the link ID to transmit on, -1 if not given; note | |
3701 | * that the link ID isn't validated (much), it's in range but the | |
3702 | * link might not exist (or be used by the receiver STA) | |
3703 | */ | |
3704 | struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params { | |
3705 | struct ieee80211_channel *chan; | |
3706 | bool offchan; | |
3707 | unsigned int wait; | |
3708 | const u8 *buf; | |
3709 | size_t len; | |
3710 | bool no_cck; | |
3711 | bool dont_wait_for_ack; | |
3712 | int n_csa_offsets; | |
3713 | const u16 *csa_offsets; | |
3714 | int link_id; | |
3715 | }; | |
3716 | ||
3717 | /** | |
3718 | * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception | |
3719 | * | |
3720 | * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition | |
3721 | * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs | |
3722 | */ | |
3723 | struct cfg80211_dscp_exception { | |
3724 | u8 dscp; | |
3725 | u8 up; | |
3726 | }; | |
3727 | ||
3728 | /** | |
3729 | * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority | |
3730 | * | |
3731 | * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive | |
3732 | * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive | |
3733 | */ | |
3734 | struct cfg80211_dscp_range { | |
3735 | u8 low; | |
3736 | u8 high; | |
3737 | }; | |
3738 | ||
3739 | /* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */ | |
3740 | #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX 21 | |
3741 | #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN 16 | |
3742 | #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \ | |
3743 | (IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX) | |
3744 | ||
3745 | /** | |
3746 | * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information | |
3747 | * | |
3748 | * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values | |
3749 | * | |
3750 | * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21) | |
3751 | * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from | |
3752 | * the user priority DSCP range definition | |
3753 | * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority | |
3754 | */ | |
3755 | struct cfg80211_qos_map { | |
3756 | u8 num_des; | |
3757 | struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX]; | |
3758 | struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8]; | |
3759 | }; | |
3760 | ||
3761 | /** | |
3762 | * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration | |
3763 | * | |
3764 | * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters | |
3765 | * | |
3766 | * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255) | |
3767 | * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values. | |
3768 | * For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set | |
3769 | * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)). | |
3770 | */ | |
3771 | struct cfg80211_nan_conf { | |
3772 | u8 master_pref; | |
3773 | u8 bands; | |
3774 | }; | |
3775 | ||
3776 | /** | |
3777 | * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN | |
3778 | * configuration | |
3779 | * | |
3780 | * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference | |
3781 | * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands | |
3782 | */ | |
3783 | enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes { | |
3784 | CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0), | |
3785 | CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1), | |
3786 | }; | |
3787 | ||
3788 | /** | |
3789 | * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter | |
3790 | * | |
3791 | * @filter: the content of the filter | |
3792 | * @len: the length of the filter | |
3793 | */ | |
3794 | struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter { | |
3795 | const u8 *filter; | |
3796 | u8 len; | |
3797 | }; | |
3798 | ||
3799 | /** | |
3800 | * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function | |
3801 | * | |
3802 | * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type | |
3803 | * @service_id: the service ID of the function | |
3804 | * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type | |
3805 | * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is | |
3806 | * implementation specific. | |
3807 | * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted | |
3808 | * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active | |
3809 | * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up | |
3810 | * @followup_reqid: the requester instance ID for follow up | |
3811 | * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up | |
3812 | * @ttl: time to live counter in DW. | |
3813 | * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info | |
3814 | * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length | |
3815 | * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive | |
3816 | * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter | |
3817 | * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length | |
3818 | * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index | |
3819 | * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses | |
3820 | * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF | |
3821 | * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter | |
3822 | * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF. | |
3823 | * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters. | |
3824 | * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters. | |
3825 | * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function. | |
3826 | * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier. | |
3827 | */ | |
3828 | struct cfg80211_nan_func { | |
3829 | enum nl80211_nan_function_type type; | |
3830 | u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN]; | |
3831 | u8 publish_type; | |
3832 | bool close_range; | |
3833 | bool publish_bcast; | |
3834 | bool subscribe_active; | |
3835 | u8 followup_id; | |
3836 | u8 followup_reqid; | |
3837 | struct mac_address followup_dest; | |
3838 | u32 ttl; | |
3839 | const u8 *serv_spec_info; | |
3840 | u8 serv_spec_info_len; | |
3841 | bool srf_include; | |
3842 | const u8 *srf_bf; | |
3843 | u8 srf_bf_len; | |
3844 | u8 srf_bf_idx; | |
3845 | struct mac_address *srf_macs; | |
3846 | int srf_num_macs; | |
3847 | struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters; | |
3848 | struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters; | |
3849 | u8 num_tx_filters; | |
3850 | u8 num_rx_filters; | |
3851 | u8 instance_id; | |
3852 | u64 cookie; | |
3853 | }; | |
3854 | ||
3855 | /** | |
3856 | * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration | |
3857 | * | |
3858 | * @aa: authenticator address | |
3859 | * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes. | |
3860 | * @pmk: the PMK material | |
3861 | * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK | |
3862 | * is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field | |
3863 | * holds PMK-R0. | |
3864 | */ | |
3865 | struct cfg80211_pmk_conf { | |
3866 | const u8 *aa; | |
3867 | u8 pmk_len; | |
3868 | const u8 *pmk; | |
3869 | const u8 *pmk_r0_name; | |
3870 | }; | |
3871 | ||
3872 | /** | |
3873 | * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication. | |
3874 | * | |
3875 | * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces. | |
3876 | * | |
3877 | * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant | |
3878 | * for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space). | |
3879 | * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has | |
3880 | * to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and | |
3881 | * authentication response command interface. | |
3882 | * @ssid: SSID of the AP. Used by both the authentication request event and | |
3883 | * authentication response command interface. | |
3884 | * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the | |
3885 | * authentication request event interface. | |
3886 | * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication, | |
3887 | * use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you | |
3888 | * the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication | |
3889 | * response command interface (user space to driver). | |
3890 | * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA. | |
3891 | * @mld_addr: MLD address of the peer. Used by the authentication request event | |
3892 | * interface. Driver indicates this to enable MLO during the authentication | |
3893 | * offload to user space. Driver shall look at %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT | |
3894 | * flag capability in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space | |
3895 | * supports enabling MLO during the authentication offload. | |
3896 | * User space should use the address of the interface (on which the | |
3897 | * authentication request event reported) as self MLD address. User space | |
3898 | * and driver should use MLD addresses in RA, TA and BSSID fields of | |
3899 | * authentication frames sent or received via cfg80211. The driver | |
3900 | * translates the MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link | |
3901 | * chosen for the authentication. | |
3902 | */ | |
3903 | struct cfg80211_external_auth_params { | |
3904 | enum nl80211_external_auth_action action; | |
3905 | u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | |
3906 | struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; | |
3907 | unsigned int key_mgmt_suite; | |
3908 | u16 status; | |
3909 | const u8 *pmkid; | |
3910 | u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | |
3911 | }; | |
3912 | ||
3913 | /** | |
3914 | * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics | |
3915 | * | |
3916 | * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to | |
3917 | * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them | |
3918 | * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully | |
3919 | * answered | |
3920 | * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were | |
3921 | * successfully answered | |
3922 | * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions | |
3923 | * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions | |
3924 | * @non_asap_num: number of non-ASAP FTM sessions | |
3925 | * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication | |
3926 | * of how much time the responder was busy | |
3927 | * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from | |
3928 | * initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with | |
3929 | * the responder | |
3930 | * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks | |
3931 | * for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot | |
3932 | * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window | |
3933 | */ | |
3934 | struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats { | |
3935 | u32 filled; | |
3936 | u32 success_num; | |
3937 | u32 partial_num; | |
3938 | u32 failed_num; | |
3939 | u32 asap_num; | |
3940 | u32 non_asap_num; | |
3941 | u64 total_duration_ms; | |
3942 | u32 unknown_triggers_num; | |
3943 | u32 reschedule_requests_num; | |
3944 | u32 out_of_window_triggers_num; | |
3945 | }; | |
3946 | ||
3947 | /** | |
3948 | * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result | |
3949 | * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is | |
3950 | * %NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise | |
3951 | * reason than just "failure" | |
3952 | * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index | |
3953 | * in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported | |
3954 | * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted | |
3955 | * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked | |
3956 | * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY, | |
3957 | * fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible | |
3958 | * by the responder | |
3959 | * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated | |
3960 | * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated | |
3961 | * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated | |
3962 | * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present) | |
3963 | * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present) | |
3964 | * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL) | |
3965 | * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL) | |
3966 | * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported | |
3967 | * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported | |
3968 | * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response | |
3969 | * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame | |
3970 | * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg) | |
3971 | * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is | |
3972 | * the square root of the variance) | |
3973 | * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured | |
3974 | * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured | |
3975 | * (must have either this or @rtt_avg) | |
3976 | * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance) | |
3977 | * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread) | |
3978 | * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid | |
3979 | * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid | |
3980 | * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid | |
3981 | * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid | |
3982 | * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid | |
3983 | * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid | |
3984 | * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid | |
3985 | * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid | |
3986 | * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid | |
3987 | * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid | |
3988 | * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid | |
3989 | * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid | |
3990 | */ | |
3991 | struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result { | |
3992 | const u8 *lci; | |
3993 | const u8 *civicloc; | |
3994 | unsigned int lci_len; | |
3995 | unsigned int civicloc_len; | |
3996 | enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason; | |
3997 | u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes; | |
3998 | s16 burst_index; | |
3999 | u8 busy_retry_time; | |
4000 | u8 num_bursts_exp; | |
4001 | u8 burst_duration; | |
4002 | u8 ftms_per_burst; | |
4003 | s32 rssi_avg; | |
4004 | s32 rssi_spread; | |
4005 | struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate; | |
4006 | s64 rtt_avg; | |
4007 | s64 rtt_variance; | |
4008 | s64 rtt_spread; | |
4009 | s64 dist_avg; | |
4010 | s64 dist_variance; | |
4011 | s64 dist_spread; | |
4012 | ||
4013 | u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1, | |
4014 | num_ftmr_successes_valid:1, | |
4015 | rssi_avg_valid:1, | |
4016 | rssi_spread_valid:1, | |
4017 | tx_rate_valid:1, | |
4018 | rx_rate_valid:1, | |
4019 | rtt_avg_valid:1, | |
4020 | rtt_variance_valid:1, | |
4021 | rtt_spread_valid:1, | |
4022 | dist_avg_valid:1, | |
4023 | dist_variance_valid:1, | |
4024 | dist_spread_valid:1; | |
4025 | }; | |
4026 | ||
4027 | /** | |
4028 | * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result | |
4029 | * @addr: address of the peer | |
4030 | * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the | |
4031 | * measurement was made) | |
4032 | * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time | |
4033 | * @status: status of the measurement | |
4034 | * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not | |
4035 | * reporting partial results always set this flag | |
4036 | * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid | |
4037 | * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting | |
4038 | * one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and | |
4039 | * they're all aggregated for userspace. | |
4040 | * @ftm: FTM result | |
4041 | */ | |
4042 | struct cfg80211_pmsr_result { | |
4043 | u64 host_time, ap_tsf; | |
4044 | enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status; | |
4045 | ||
4046 | u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; | |
4047 | ||
4048 | u8 final:1, | |
4049 | ap_tsf_valid:1; | |
4050 | ||
4051 | enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type; | |
4052 | ||
4053 | union { | |
4054 | struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm; | |
4055 | }; | |
4056 | }; | |
4057 | ||
4058 | /** | |
4059 | * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data | |
4060 | * @requested: indicates FTM is requested | |
4061 | * @preamble: frame preamble to use | |
4062 | * @burst_period: burst period to use | |
4063 | * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode | |
4064 | * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent | |
4065 | * @burst_duration: burst duration | |
4066 | * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst | |
4067 | * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request | |
4068 | * @request_lci: request LCI information | |
4069 | * @request_civicloc: request civic location information | |
4070 | * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement | |
4071 | * If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set, | |
4072 | * EDCA based ranging will be used. | |
4073 | * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement | |
4074 | * If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set, | |
4075 | * EDCA based ranging will be used. | |
4076 | * @lmr_feedback: negotiate for I2R LMR feedback. Only valid if either | |
4077 | * @trigger_based or @non_trigger_based is set. | |
4078 | * @bss_color: the bss color of the responder. Optional. Set to zero to | |
4079 | * indicate the driver should set the BSS color. Only valid if | |
4080 | * @non_trigger_based or @trigger_based is set. | |
4081 | * | |
4082 | * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation. | |
4083 | */ | |
4084 | struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer { | |
4085 | enum nl80211_preamble preamble; | |
4086 | u16 burst_period; | |
4087 | u8 requested:1, | |
4088 | asap:1, | |
4089 | request_lci:1, | |
4090 | request_civicloc:1, | |
4091 | trigger_based:1, | |
4092 | non_trigger_based:1, | |
4093 | lmr_feedback:1; | |
4094 | u8 num_bursts_exp; | |
4095 | u8 burst_duration; | |
4096 | u8 ftms_per_burst; | |
4097 | u8 ftmr_retries; | |
4098 | u8 bss_color; | |
4099 | }; | |
4100 | ||
4101 | /** | |
4102 | * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request | |
4103 | * @addr: MAC address | |
4104 | * @chandef: channel to use | |
4105 | * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF | |
4106 | * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer | |
4107 | */ | |
4108 | struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer { | |
4109 | u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; | |
4110 | struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; | |
4111 | u8 report_ap_tsf:1; | |
4112 | struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm; | |
4113 | }; | |
4114 | ||
4115 | /** | |
4116 | * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request | |
4117 | * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211 | |
4118 | * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211 | |
4119 | * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting, | |
4120 | * not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211 | |
4121 | * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request | |
4122 | * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that | |
4123 | * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should | |
4124 | * be taken from the @mac_addr | |
4125 | * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request | |
4126 | * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if | |
4127 | * zero it means there's no timeout | |
4128 | * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with | |
4129 | * @peers: per-peer measurement request data | |
4130 | */ | |
4131 | struct cfg80211_pmsr_request { | |
4132 | u64 cookie; | |
4133 | void *drv_data; | |
4134 | u32 n_peers; | |
4135 | u32 nl_portid; | |
4136 | ||
4137 | u32 timeout; | |
4138 | ||
4139 | u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | |
4140 | u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | |
4141 | ||
4142 | struct list_head list; | |
4143 | ||
4144 | struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[] __counted_by(n_peers); | |
4145 | }; | |
4146 | ||
4147 | /** | |
4148 | * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information | |
4149 | * | |
4150 | * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE | |
4151 | * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space. | |
4152 | * | |
4153 | * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces. | |
4154 | * | |
4155 | * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing | |
4156 | * has to be done. | |
4157 | * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info | |
4158 | * processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space | |
4159 | * cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for | |
4160 | * OWE update request command interface (user space to driver). | |
4161 | * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are | |
4162 | * the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and | |
4163 | * the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface. | |
4164 | * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets. | |
4165 | * @assoc_link_id: MLO link ID of the AP, with which (re)association requested | |
4166 | * by peer. This will be filled by driver for both MLO and non-MLO station | |
4167 | * connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD. For non-MLD AP mode, it | |
4168 | * will be -1. Used only with OWE update event (driver to user space). | |
4169 | * @peer_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the peer. For non-MLO | |
4170 | * connection, it will be all zeros. This is applicable only when | |
4171 | * @assoc_link_id is not -1, i.e., the AP affiliated with an MLD. Used only | |
4172 | * with OWE update event (driver to user space). | |
4173 | */ | |
4174 | struct cfg80211_update_owe_info { | |
4175 | u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | |
4176 | u16 status; | |
4177 | const u8 *ie; | |
4178 | size_t ie_len; | |
4179 | int assoc_link_id; | |
4180 | u8 peer_mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | |
4181 | }; | |
4182 | ||
4183 | /** | |
4184 | * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data | |
4185 | * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered | |
4186 | * for the entire device | |
4187 | * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered | |
4188 | * for the given interface | |
4189 | * @global_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes | |
4190 | * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface | |
4191 | * for these subtypes | |
4192 | */ | |
4193 | struct mgmt_frame_regs { | |
4194 | u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes; | |
4195 | u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes; | |
4196 | }; | |
4197 | ||
4198 | /** | |
4199 | * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration | |
4200 | * | |
4201 | * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks | |
4202 | * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces. | |
4203 | * | |
4204 | * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0 | |
4205 | * on success or a negative error code. | |
4206 | * | |
4207 | * All operations are invoked with the wiphy mutex held. The RTNL may be | |
4208 | * held in addition (due to wireless extensions) but this cannot be relied | |
4209 | * upon except in cases where documented below. Note that due to ordering, | |
4210 | * the RTNL also cannot be acquired in any handlers. | |
4211 | * | |
4212 | * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will | |
4213 | * be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are | |
4214 | * configured for the device. | |
4215 | * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed | |
4216 | * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback | |
4217 | * to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from | |
4218 | * the device. | |
4219 | * | |
4220 | * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name, | |
4221 | * must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create | |
4222 | * the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct | |
4223 | * wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must | |
4224 | * also set the address member in the wdev. | |
4225 | * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes. | |
4226 | * | |
4227 | * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface | |
4228 | * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes. | |
4229 | * | |
4230 | * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface, | |
4231 | * keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated. | |
4232 | * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes. | |
4233 | * | |
4234 | * @add_intf_link: Add a new MLO link to the given interface. Note that | |
4235 | * the wdev->link[] data structure has been updated, so the new link | |
4236 | * address is available. | |
4237 | * @del_intf_link: Remove an MLO link from the given interface. | |
4238 | * | |
4239 | * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL | |
4240 | * when adding a group key. @link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection. | |
4241 | * For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for | |
4242 | * pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. | |
4243 | * | |
4244 | * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters. | |
4245 | * @mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group | |
4246 | * key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid | |
4247 | * after it returns. This function should return an error if it is | |
4248 | * not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist. | |
4249 | * @link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection, | |
4250 | * @link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr | |
4251 | * will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. | |
4252 | * | |
4253 | * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key) | |
4254 | * and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist. @link_id will | |
4255 | * be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0 | |
4256 | * for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD | |
4257 | * address for MLO pairwise key. | |
4258 | * | |
4259 | * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface. @link_id will be >= 0 | |
4260 | * for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection. | |
4261 | * | |
4262 | * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface. | |
4263 | * @link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection. | |
4264 | * | |
4265 | * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface. | |
4266 | * @link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection. | |
4267 | * | |
4268 | * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver | |
4269 | * | |
4270 | * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters. | |
4271 | * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode | |
4272 | * interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started. | |
4273 | * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing. | |
4274 | * | |
4275 | * @add_station: Add a new station. | |
4276 | * @del_station: Remove a station | |
4277 | * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much | |
4278 | * validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags | |
4279 | * might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check | |
4280 | * them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call | |
4281 | * cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information. | |
4282 | * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac | |
4283 | * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx | |
4284 | * | |
4285 | * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path | |
4286 | * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path | |
4287 | * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path | |
4288 | * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters | |
4289 | * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx | |
4290 | * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters | |
4291 | * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx | |
4292 | * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters | |
4293 | * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) | |
4294 | * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network | |
4295 | * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) | |
4296 | * | |
4297 | * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration | |
4298 | * | |
4299 | * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh. | |
4300 | * The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to | |
4301 | * set, and which to leave alone. | |
4302 | * | |
4303 | * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS. | |
4304 | * | |
4305 | * @inform_bss: Called by cfg80211 while being informed about new BSS data | |
4306 | * for every BSS found within the reported data or frame. This is called | |
4307 | * from within the cfg8011 inform_bss handlers while holding the bss_lock. | |
4308 | * The data parameter is passed through from drv_data inside | |
4309 | * struct cfg80211_inform_bss. | |
4310 | * The new IE data for the BSS is explicitly passed. | |
4311 | * | |
4312 | * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters | |
4313 | * | |
4314 | * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas, | |
4315 | * as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to | |
4316 | * join the mesh instead. | |
4317 | * | |
4318 | * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other | |
4319 | * interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration. | |
4320 | * If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should | |
4321 | * be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active. | |
4322 | * | |
4323 | * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given | |
4324 | * the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done(). | |
4325 | * For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside | |
4326 | * the scan/scan_done bracket too. | |
4327 | * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall | |
4328 | * indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done(). | |
4329 | * | |
4330 | * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer | |
4331 | * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) | |
4332 | * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer | |
4333 | * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) | |
4334 | * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer | |
4335 | * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) | |
4336 | * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer | |
4337 | * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) | |
4338 | * | |
4339 | * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected, | |
4340 | * call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code | |
4341 | * %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call | |
4342 | * cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code | |
4343 | * from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code | |
4344 | * was received. | |
4345 | * The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the | |
4346 | * other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated | |
4347 | * by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches | |
4348 | * the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request | |
4349 | * frame instead of Association Request frame. | |
4350 | * The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a | |
4351 | * specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid | |
4352 | * parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an | |
4353 | * indication of requesting reassociation. | |
4354 | * In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming | |
4355 | * cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to | |
4356 | * cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) | |
4357 | * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a | |
4358 | * BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for | |
4359 | * subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the | |
4360 | * Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not | |
4361 | * request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current | |
4362 | * BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in | |
4363 | * changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed. | |
4364 | * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) | |
4365 | * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if | |
4366 | * connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in | |
4367 | * case connection was already established (invoked with the | |
4368 | * wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout(). | |
4369 | * | |
4370 | * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call | |
4371 | * cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due | |
4372 | * to a merge. | |
4373 | * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) | |
4374 | * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS. | |
4375 | * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) | |
4376 | * | |
4377 | * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or | |
4378 | * MESH mode) | |
4379 | * | |
4380 | * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed; | |
4381 | * @changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values | |
4382 | * have changed. The actual parameter values are available in | |
4383 | * struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed. | |
4384 | * | |
4385 | * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters, | |
4386 | * the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The | |
4387 | * wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will | |
4388 | * always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power | |
4389 | * (as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.) | |
4390 | * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable; | |
4391 | * return 0 if successful | |
4392 | * | |
4393 | * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting | |
4394 | * functions to adjust rfkill hw state | |
4395 | * | |
4396 | * @dump_survey: get site survey information. | |
4397 | * | |
4398 | * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified | |
4399 | * channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel | |
4400 | * operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is | |
4401 | * ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event | |
4402 | * notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel(). | |
4403 | * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation. | |
4404 | * This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on | |
4405 | * the duration value. | |
4406 | * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame. | |
4407 | * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management | |
4408 | * frame on another channel | |
4409 | * | |
4410 | * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL | |
4411 | * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be | |
4412 | * used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally, | |
4413 | * return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the | |
4414 | * dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data | |
4415 | * was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present | |
4416 | * and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA. | |
4417 | * | |
4418 | * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration | |
4419 | * | |
4420 | * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac | |
4421 | * devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association | |
4422 | * RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs. | |
4423 | * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID. | |
4424 | * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs. | |
4425 | * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1 | |
4426 | * allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value. | |
4427 | * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold. | |
4428 | * After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating | |
4429 | * the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may | |
4430 | * need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being | |
4431 | * disabled.) | |
4432 | * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the | |
4433 | * connection quality monitor. An event is to be sent only when the | |
4434 | * signal level is found to be outside the two values. The driver should | |
4435 | * set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented. | |
4436 | * If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config. | |
4437 | * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error | |
4438 | * thresholds. | |
4439 | * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan. | |
4440 | * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with | |
4441 | * given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready | |
4442 | * for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be | |
4443 | * called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case. | |
4444 | * The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested | |
4445 | * stop (when this method returns 0). | |
4446 | * | |
4447 | * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame | |
4448 | * registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep. | |
4449 | * | |
4450 | * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device. | |
4451 | * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may | |
4452 | * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL | |
4453 | * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX). | |
4454 | * | |
4455 | * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant). | |
4456 | * | |
4457 | * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame. | |
4458 | * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup). | |
4459 | * | |
4460 | * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it | |
4461 | * later passes to cfg80211_probe_status(). | |
4462 | * | |
4463 | * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs. | |
4464 | * | |
4465 | * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface. | |
4466 | * For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single | |
4467 | * current monitoring channel. | |
4468 | * | |
4469 | * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device. | |
4470 | * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device. | |
4471 | * | |
4472 | * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode. | |
4473 | * Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations | |
4474 | * and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver | |
4475 | * this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL | |
4476 | * when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which | |
4477 | * advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback. | |
4478 | * | |
4479 | * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver. | |
4480 | * | |
4481 | * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC | |
4482 | * was finished on another phy. | |
4483 | * | |
4484 | * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the | |
4485 | * driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be | |
4486 | * used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames. | |
4487 | * | |
4488 | * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability | |
4489 | * for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the | |
4490 | * driver can take the most appropriate actions. | |
4491 | * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link | |
4492 | * reliability. This operation can not fail. | |
4493 | * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters. | |
4494 | * | |
4495 | * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is | |
4496 | * responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is | |
4497 | * inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later | |
4498 | * with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept | |
4499 | * everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them | |
4500 | * as soon as possible. | |
4501 | * | |
4502 | * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver | |
4503 | * | |
4504 | * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the | |
4505 | * given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width | |
4506 | * changes during the lifetime of the BSS. | |
4507 | * | |
4508 | * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device | |
4509 | * with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by | |
4510 | * userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into | |
4511 | * account. | |
4512 | * If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure | |
4513 | * the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return | |
4514 | * success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake | |
4515 | * with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later | |
4516 | * rejected) | |
4517 | * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS | |
4518 | * | |
4519 | * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters | |
4520 | * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) | |
4521 | * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network | |
4522 | * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) | |
4523 | * | |
4524 | * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver | |
4525 | * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations | |
4526 | * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. | |
4527 | * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both | |
4528 | * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes. | |
4529 | * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface. | |
4530 | * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface. | |
4531 | * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure. | |
4532 | * On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and | |
4533 | * it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver | |
4534 | * should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling | |
4535 | * cfg80211_free_nan_func(). | |
4536 | * On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the | |
4537 | * provided @nan_func. | |
4538 | * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function. | |
4539 | * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must | |
4540 | * be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes); | |
4541 | * All other parameters must be ignored. | |
4542 | * | |
4543 | * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS | |
4544 | * | |
4545 | * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this | |
4546 | * function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise. | |
4547 | * | |
4548 | * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake. | |
4549 | * If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect | |
4550 | * upon which the driver should clear it. | |
4551 | * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) | |
4552 | * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator. | |
4553 | * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) | |
4554 | * | |
4555 | * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from | |
4556 | * user space | |
4557 | * | |
4558 | * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL). The noencrypt parameter | |
4559 | * tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted. | |
4560 | * | |
4561 | * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available. | |
4562 | * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided. | |
4563 | * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) | |
4564 | * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement | |
4565 | * | |
4566 | * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME | |
4567 | * but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated | |
4568 | * DH IE through this interface. | |
4569 | * | |
4570 | * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame | |
4571 | * and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm. | |
4572 | * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific | |
4573 | * This callback may sleep. | |
4574 | * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the | |
4575 | * given TIDs. This callback may sleep. | |
4576 | * | |
4577 | * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings. | |
4578 | * | |
4579 | * @color_change: Initiate a color change. | |
4580 | * | |
4581 | * @set_fils_aad: Set FILS AAD data to the AP driver so that the driver can use | |
4582 | * those to decrypt (Re)Association Request and encrypt (Re)Association | |
4583 | * Response frame. | |
4584 | * | |
4585 | * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for | |
4586 | * radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit | |
4587 | * or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev. | |
4588 | * Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime | |
4589 | * switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected | |
4590 | * radar channel. | |
4591 | * The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to | |
4592 | * disable background CAC/radar detection. | |
4593 | * @add_link_station: Add a link to a station. | |
4594 | * @mod_link_station: Modify a link of a station. | |
4595 | * @del_link_station: Remove a link of a station. | |
4596 | * | |
4597 | * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. | |
4598 | * @set_ttlm: set the TID to link mapping. | |
4599 | * @set_epcs: Enable/Disable EPCS for station mode. | |
4600 | * @get_radio_mask: get bitmask of radios in use. | |
4601 | * (invoked with the wiphy mutex held) | |
4602 | * @assoc_ml_reconf: Request a non-AP MLO connection to perform ML | |
4603 | * reconfiguration, i.e., add and/or remove links to/from the | |
4604 | * association using ML reconfiguration action frames. Successfully added | |
4605 | * links will be added to the set of valid links. Successfully removed | |
4606 | * links will be removed from the set of valid links. The driver must | |
4607 | * indicate removed links by calling cfg80211_links_removed() and added | |
4608 | * links by calling cfg80211_mlo_reconf_add_done(). When calling | |
4609 | * cfg80211_mlo_reconf_add_done() the bss pointer must be given for each | |
4610 | * link for which MLO reconfiguration 'add' operation was requested. | |
4611 | */ | |
4612 | struct cfg80211_ops { | |
4613 | int (*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow); | |
4614 | int (*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy); | |
4615 | void (*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled); | |
4616 | ||
4617 | struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4618 | const char *name, | |
4619 | unsigned char name_assign_type, | |
4620 | enum nl80211_iftype type, | |
4621 | struct vif_params *params); | |
4622 | int (*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4623 | struct wireless_dev *wdev); | |
4624 | int (*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4625 | struct net_device *dev, | |
4626 | enum nl80211_iftype type, | |
4627 | struct vif_params *params); | |
4628 | ||
4629 | int (*add_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4630 | struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
4631 | unsigned int link_id); | |
4632 | void (*del_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4633 | struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
4634 | unsigned int link_id); | |
4635 | ||
4636 | int (*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, | |
4637 | int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise, | |
4638 | const u8 *mac_addr, struct key_params *params); | |
4639 | int (*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, | |
4640 | int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise, | |
4641 | const u8 *mac_addr, void *cookie, | |
4642 | void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*)); | |
4643 | int (*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, | |
4644 | int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise, | |
4645 | const u8 *mac_addr); | |
4646 | int (*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4647 | struct net_device *netdev, int link_id, | |
4648 | u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast); | |
4649 | int (*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4650 | struct net_device *netdev, int link_id, | |
4651 | u8 key_index); | |
4652 | int (*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4653 | struct net_device *netdev, | |
4654 | int link_id, | |
4655 | u8 key_index); | |
4656 | ||
4657 | int (*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4658 | struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings); | |
4659 | int (*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4660 | struct cfg80211_ap_update *info); | |
4661 | int (*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4662 | unsigned int link_id); | |
4663 | ||
4664 | ||
4665 | int (*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4666 | const u8 *mac, | |
4667 | struct station_parameters *params); | |
4668 | int (*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4669 | struct station_del_parameters *params); | |
4670 | int (*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4671 | const u8 *mac, | |
4672 | struct station_parameters *params); | |
4673 | int (*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4674 | const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo); | |
4675 | int (*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4676 | int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo); | |
4677 | ||
4678 | int (*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4679 | const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop); | |
4680 | int (*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4681 | const u8 *dst); | |
4682 | int (*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4683 | const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop); | |
4684 | int (*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4685 | u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo); | |
4686 | int (*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4687 | int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, | |
4688 | struct mpath_info *pinfo); | |
4689 | int (*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4690 | u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo); | |
4691 | int (*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4692 | int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, | |
4693 | struct mpath_info *pinfo); | |
4694 | int (*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4695 | struct net_device *dev, | |
4696 | struct mesh_config *conf); | |
4697 | int (*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4698 | struct net_device *dev, u32 mask, | |
4699 | const struct mesh_config *nconf); | |
4700 | int (*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4701 | const struct mesh_config *conf, | |
4702 | const struct mesh_setup *setup); | |
4703 | int (*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); | |
4704 | ||
4705 | int (*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4706 | struct ocb_setup *setup); | |
4707 | int (*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); | |
4708 | ||
4709 | int (*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4710 | struct bss_parameters *params); | |
4711 | ||
4712 | void (*inform_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss, | |
4713 | const struct cfg80211_bss_ies *ies, void *data); | |
4714 | ||
4715 | int (*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4716 | struct ieee80211_txq_params *params); | |
4717 | ||
4718 | int (*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4719 | struct net_device *dev, | |
4720 | struct ieee80211_channel *chan); | |
4721 | ||
4722 | int (*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4723 | struct net_device *dev, | |
4724 | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); | |
4725 | ||
4726 | int (*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4727 | struct cfg80211_scan_request *request); | |
4728 | void (*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev); | |
4729 | ||
4730 | int (*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4731 | struct cfg80211_auth_request *req); | |
4732 | int (*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4733 | struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req); | |
4734 | int (*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4735 | struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req); | |
4736 | int (*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4737 | struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req); | |
4738 | ||
4739 | int (*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4740 | struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme); | |
4741 | int (*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4742 | struct net_device *dev, | |
4743 | struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme, | |
4744 | u32 changed); | |
4745 | int (*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4746 | u16 reason_code); | |
4747 | ||
4748 | int (*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4749 | struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params); | |
4750 | int (*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); | |
4751 | ||
4752 | int (*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4753 | int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]); | |
4754 | ||
4755 | int (*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed); | |
4756 | ||
4757 | int (*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
4758 | enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm); | |
4759 | int (*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
4760 | unsigned int link_id, int *dbm); | |
4761 | ||
4762 | void (*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy); | |
4763 | ||
4764 | #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE | |
4765 | int (*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
4766 | void *data, int len); | |
4767 | int (*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb, | |
4768 | struct netlink_callback *cb, | |
4769 | void *data, int len); | |
4770 | #endif | |
4771 | ||
4772 | int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4773 | struct net_device *dev, | |
4774 | unsigned int link_id, | |
4775 | const u8 *peer, | |
4776 | const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask); | |
4777 | ||
4778 | int (*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, | |
4779 | int idx, struct survey_info *info); | |
4780 | ||
4781 | int (*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, | |
4782 | struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa); | |
4783 | int (*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, | |
4784 | struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa); | |
4785 | int (*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev); | |
4786 | ||
4787 | int (*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4788 | struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
4789 | struct ieee80211_channel *chan, | |
4790 | unsigned int duration, | |
4791 | u64 *cookie); | |
4792 | int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4793 | struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
4794 | u64 cookie); | |
4795 | ||
4796 | int (*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
4797 | struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params, | |
4798 | u64 *cookie); | |
4799 | int (*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4800 | struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
4801 | u64 cookie); | |
4802 | ||
4803 | int (*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4804 | bool enabled, int timeout); | |
4805 | ||
4806 | int (*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4807 | struct net_device *dev, | |
4808 | s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst); | |
4809 | ||
4810 | int (*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4811 | struct net_device *dev, | |
4812 | s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high); | |
4813 | ||
4814 | int (*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4815 | struct net_device *dev, | |
4816 | u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl); | |
4817 | ||
4818 | void (*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4819 | struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
4820 | struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd); | |
4821 | ||
4822 | int (*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant); | |
4823 | int (*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant); | |
4824 | ||
4825 | int (*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4826 | struct net_device *dev, | |
4827 | struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request); | |
4828 | int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4829 | u64 reqid); | |
4830 | ||
4831 | int (*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4832 | struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data); | |
4833 | ||
4834 | int (*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4835 | const u8 *peer, int link_id, | |
4836 | u8 action_code, u8 dialog_token, u16 status_code, | |
4837 | u32 peer_capability, bool initiator, | |
4838 | const u8 *buf, size_t len); | |
4839 | int (*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4840 | const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper); | |
4841 | ||
4842 | int (*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4843 | const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie); | |
4844 | ||
4845 | int (*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4846 | struct net_device *dev, | |
4847 | u16 noack_map); | |
4848 | ||
4849 | int (*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4850 | struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
4851 | unsigned int link_id, | |
4852 | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); | |
4853 | ||
4854 | int (*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4855 | struct wireless_dev *wdev); | |
4856 | void (*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4857 | struct wireless_dev *wdev); | |
4858 | ||
4859 | int (*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4860 | const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params); | |
4861 | ||
4862 | int (*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4863 | struct net_device *dev, | |
4864 | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | |
4865 | u32 cac_time_ms, int link_id); | |
4866 | void (*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4867 | struct net_device *dev, unsigned int link_id); | |
4868 | int (*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4869 | struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie); | |
4870 | int (*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4871 | struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
4872 | enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol, | |
4873 | u16 duration); | |
4874 | void (*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4875 | struct wireless_dev *wdev); | |
4876 | int (*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4877 | struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce); | |
4878 | ||
4879 | int (*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4880 | struct net_device *dev, | |
4881 | struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params); | |
4882 | ||
4883 | int (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4884 | struct net_device *dev, | |
4885 | struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map); | |
4886 | ||
4887 | int (*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4888 | unsigned int link_id, | |
4889 | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); | |
4890 | ||
4891 | int (*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4892 | u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio, | |
4893 | u16 admitted_time); | |
4894 | int (*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4895 | u8 tsid, const u8 *peer); | |
4896 | ||
4897 | int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4898 | struct net_device *dev, | |
4899 | const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class, | |
4900 | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); | |
4901 | void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4902 | struct net_device *dev, | |
4903 | const u8 *addr); | |
4904 | int (*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
4905 | struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf); | |
4906 | void (*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev); | |
4907 | int (*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
4908 | struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func); | |
4909 | void (*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
4910 | u64 cookie); | |
4911 | int (*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4912 | struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
4913 | struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, | |
4914 | u32 changes); | |
4915 | ||
4916 | int (*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4917 | struct net_device *dev, | |
4918 | const bool enabled); | |
4919 | ||
4920 | int (*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4921 | struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
4922 | struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats); | |
4923 | ||
4924 | int (*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4925 | const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf); | |
4926 | int (*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4927 | const u8 *aa); | |
4928 | int (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4929 | struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params); | |
4930 | ||
4931 | int (*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4932 | struct net_device *dev, | |
4933 | const u8 *buf, size_t len, | |
4934 | const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto, | |
4935 | const bool noencrypt, int link_id, | |
4936 | u64 *cookie); | |
4937 | ||
4938 | int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4939 | struct net_device *dev, | |
4940 | struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats); | |
4941 | ||
4942 | int (*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
4943 | struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); | |
4944 | void (*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
4945 | struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); | |
4946 | int (*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4947 | struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info); | |
4948 | int (*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4949 | const u8 *buf, size_t len); | |
4950 | int (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4951 | struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf); | |
4952 | int (*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4953 | const u8 *peer, u8 tids); | |
4954 | int (*set_sar_specs)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4955 | struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar); | |
4956 | int (*color_change)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4957 | struct net_device *dev, | |
4958 | struct cfg80211_color_change_settings *params); | |
4959 | int (*set_fils_aad)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4960 | struct cfg80211_fils_aad *fils_aad); | |
4961 | int (*set_radar_background)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
4962 | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); | |
4963 | int (*add_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4964 | struct link_station_parameters *params); | |
4965 | int (*mod_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4966 | struct link_station_parameters *params); | |
4967 | int (*del_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4968 | struct link_station_del_parameters *params); | |
4969 | int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4970 | struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts); | |
4971 | int (*set_ttlm)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4972 | struct cfg80211_ttlm_params *params); | |
4973 | u32 (*get_radio_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); | |
4974 | int (*assoc_ml_reconf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4975 | struct cfg80211_ml_reconf_req *req); | |
4976 | int (*set_epcs)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, | |
4977 | bool val); | |
4978 | }; | |
4979 | ||
4980 | /* | |
4981 | * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures | |
4982 | * and registration/helper functions | |
4983 | */ | |
4984 | ||
4985 | /** | |
4986 | * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags | |
4987 | * | |
4988 | * @WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ: if set to true, the scan request will be split | |
4989 | * into two, first for legacy bands and second for 6 GHz. | |
4990 | * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this | |
4991 | * wiphy at all | |
4992 | * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled | |
4993 | * by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default | |
4994 | * on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good | |
4995 | * reason to override the default | |
4996 | * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station | |
4997 | * on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of | |
4998 | * supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype. | |
4999 | * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station | |
5000 | * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the | |
5001 | * control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the | |
5002 | * control_port_no_encrypt flag. | |
5003 | * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN. | |
5004 | * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing | |
5005 | * auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH. | |
5006 | * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the | |
5007 | * firmware. | |
5008 | * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP. | |
5009 | * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation. | |
5010 | * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z) | |
5011 | * link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and | |
5012 | * teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT | |
5013 | * command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be | |
5014 | * used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation. | |
5015 | * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME | |
5016 | * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes | |
5017 | * when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling | |
5018 | * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(). | |
5019 | * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device | |
5020 | * responds to probe-requests in hardware. | |
5021 | * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX. | |
5022 | * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call. | |
5023 | * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels. | |
5024 | * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in | |
5025 | * beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...). | |
5026 | * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys | |
5027 | * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO: This is a temporary flag gating the MLO APIs, | |
5028 | * in order to not have them reachable in normal drivers, until we have | |
5029 | * complete feature/interface combinations/etc. advertisement. No driver | |
5030 | * should set this flag for now. | |
5031 | * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32: The device supports 32-byte KCK keys. | |
5032 | * @WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER: The device could handle reg notify for | |
5033 | * NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER. | |
5034 | * @WIPHY_FLAG_CHANNEL_CHANGE_ON_BEACON: reg_call_notifier() is called if driver | |
5035 | * set this flag to update channels on beacon hints. | |
5036 | * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_NSTR_NONPRIMARY: support connection to non-primary link | |
5037 | * of an NSTR mobile AP MLD. | |
5038 | * @WIPHY_FLAG_DISABLE_WEXT: disable wireless extensions for this device | |
5039 | */ | |
5040 | enum wiphy_flags { | |
5041 | WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK = BIT(0), | |
5042 | WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO = BIT(1), | |
5043 | WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ = BIT(2), | |
5044 | WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK = BIT(3), | |
5045 | WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT = BIT(4), | |
5046 | WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP = BIT(5), | |
5047 | WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION = BIT(6), | |
5048 | WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL = BIT(7), | |
5049 | WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN = BIT(8), | |
5050 | WIPHY_FLAG_DISABLE_WEXT = BIT(9), | |
5051 | WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH = BIT(10), | |
5052 | WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32 = BIT(11), | |
5053 | WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_NSTR_NONPRIMARY = BIT(12), | |
5054 | WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM = BIT(13), | |
5055 | WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD = BIT(14), | |
5056 | WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS = BIT(15), | |
5057 | WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP = BIT(16), | |
5058 | WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME = BIT(17), | |
5059 | WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS = BIT(18), | |
5060 | WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD = BIT(19), | |
5061 | WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX = BIT(20), | |
5062 | WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL = BIT(21), | |
5063 | WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ = BIT(22), | |
5064 | WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH = BIT(23), | |
5065 | WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER = BIT(24), | |
5066 | WIPHY_FLAG_CHANNEL_CHANGE_ON_BEACON = BIT(25), | |
5067 | }; | |
5068 | ||
5069 | /** | |
5070 | * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types | |
5071 | * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types | |
5072 | * @types: interface types (bits) | |
5073 | */ | |
5074 | struct ieee80211_iface_limit { | |
5075 | u16 max; | |
5076 | u16 types; | |
5077 | }; | |
5078 | ||
5079 | /** | |
5080 | * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination | |
5081 | * | |
5082 | * With this structure the driver can describe which interface | |
5083 | * combinations it supports concurrently. When set in a struct wiphy_radio, | |
5084 | * the combinations refer to combinations of interfaces currently active on | |
5085 | * that radio. | |
5086 | * | |
5087 | * Examples: | |
5088 | * | |
5089 | * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total: | |
5090 | * | |
5091 | * .. code-block:: c | |
5092 | * | |
5093 | * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = { | |
5094 | * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), }, | |
5095 | * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP), }, | |
5096 | * }; | |
5097 | * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = { | |
5098 | * .limits = limits1, | |
5099 | * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1), | |
5100 | * .max_interfaces = 2, | |
5101 | * .beacon_int_infra_match = true, | |
5102 | * }; | |
5103 | * | |
5104 | * | |
5105 | * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total: | |
5106 | * | |
5107 | * .. code-block:: c | |
5108 | * | |
5109 | * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = { | |
5110 | * { .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) | | |
5111 | * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), }, | |
5112 | * }; | |
5113 | * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = { | |
5114 | * .limits = limits2, | |
5115 | * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2), | |
5116 | * .max_interfaces = 8, | |
5117 | * .num_different_channels = 1, | |
5118 | * }; | |
5119 | * | |
5120 | * | |
5121 | * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total. | |
5122 | * | |
5123 | * This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections. | |
5124 | * | |
5125 | * .. code-block:: c | |
5126 | * | |
5127 | * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = { | |
5128 | * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), }, | |
5129 | * { .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) | | |
5130 | * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), }, | |
5131 | * }; | |
5132 | * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = { | |
5133 | * .limits = limits3, | |
5134 | * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3), | |
5135 | * .max_interfaces = 4, | |
5136 | * .num_different_channels = 2, | |
5137 | * }; | |
5138 | * | |
5139 | */ | |
5140 | struct ieee80211_iface_combination { | |
5141 | /** | |
5142 | * @limits: | |
5143 | * limits for the given interface types | |
5144 | */ | |
5145 | const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits; | |
5146 | ||
5147 | /** | |
5148 | * @num_different_channels: | |
5149 | * can use up to this many different channels | |
5150 | */ | |
5151 | u32 num_different_channels; | |
5152 | ||
5153 | /** | |
5154 | * @max_interfaces: | |
5155 | * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group | |
5156 | */ | |
5157 | u16 max_interfaces; | |
5158 | ||
5159 | /** | |
5160 | * @n_limits: | |
5161 | * number of limitations | |
5162 | */ | |
5163 | u8 n_limits; | |
5164 | ||
5165 | /** | |
5166 | * @beacon_int_infra_match: | |
5167 | * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure | |
5168 | * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases. | |
5169 | */ | |
5170 | bool beacon_int_infra_match; | |
5171 | ||
5172 | /** | |
5173 | * @radar_detect_widths: | |
5174 | * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection | |
5175 | */ | |
5176 | u8 radar_detect_widths; | |
5177 | ||
5178 | /** | |
5179 | * @radar_detect_regions: | |
5180 | * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection | |
5181 | */ | |
5182 | u8 radar_detect_regions; | |
5183 | ||
5184 | /** | |
5185 | * @beacon_int_min_gcd: | |
5186 | * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals. | |
5187 | * | |
5188 | * = 0 | |
5189 | * all beacon intervals for different interface must be same. | |
5190 | * > 0 | |
5191 | * any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND | |
5192 | * GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this | |
5193 | * combination must be greater or equal to this value. | |
5194 | */ | |
5195 | u32 beacon_int_min_gcd; | |
5196 | }; | |
5197 | ||
5198 | struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes { | |
5199 | u16 tx, rx; | |
5200 | }; | |
5201 | ||
5202 | /** | |
5203 | * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags | |
5204 | * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any" | |
5205 | * trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and | |
5206 | * wakes up the host on any activity, for example a | |
5207 | * received packet that passed filtering; note that the | |
5208 | * packet should be preserved in that case | |
5209 | * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet | |
5210 | * (see nl80211.h) | |
5211 | * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect | |
5212 | * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep | |
5213 | * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure | |
5214 | * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request | |
5215 | * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure | |
5216 | * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release | |
5217 | * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection | |
5218 | */ | |
5219 | enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags { | |
5220 | WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY = BIT(0), | |
5221 | WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT = BIT(1), | |
5222 | WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT = BIT(2), | |
5223 | WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY = BIT(3), | |
5224 | WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE = BIT(4), | |
5225 | WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ = BIT(5), | |
5226 | WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE = BIT(6), | |
5227 | WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE = BIT(7), | |
5228 | WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT = BIT(8), | |
5229 | }; | |
5230 | ||
5231 | struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support { | |
5232 | const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok; | |
5233 | u32 data_payload_max; | |
5234 | u32 data_interval_max; | |
5235 | u32 wake_payload_max; | |
5236 | bool seq; | |
5237 | }; | |
5238 | ||
5239 | /** | |
5240 | * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data | |
5241 | * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags | |
5242 | * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns | |
5243 | * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition) | |
5244 | * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern | |
5245 | * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern | |
5246 | * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset | |
5247 | * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect, | |
5248 | * similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for | |
5249 | * scheduled scans. | |
5250 | * See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more | |
5251 | * details. | |
5252 | * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information | |
5253 | */ | |
5254 | struct wiphy_wowlan_support { | |
5255 | u32 flags; | |
5256 | int n_patterns; | |
5257 | int pattern_max_len; | |
5258 | int pattern_min_len; | |
5259 | int max_pkt_offset; | |
5260 | int max_nd_match_sets; | |
5261 | const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp; | |
5262 | }; | |
5263 | ||
5264 | /** | |
5265 | * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data | |
5266 | * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules | |
5267 | * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs | |
5268 | * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule | |
5269 | * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition) | |
5270 | * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern | |
5271 | * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern | |
5272 | * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset | |
5273 | */ | |
5274 | struct wiphy_coalesce_support { | |
5275 | int n_rules; | |
5276 | int max_delay; | |
5277 | int n_patterns; | |
5278 | int pattern_max_len; | |
5279 | int pattern_min_len; | |
5280 | int max_pkt_offset; | |
5281 | }; | |
5282 | ||
5283 | /** | |
5284 | * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands | |
5285 | * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev | |
5286 | * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev | |
5287 | * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running | |
5288 | * (must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV) | |
5289 | */ | |
5290 | enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags { | |
5291 | WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0), | |
5292 | WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1), | |
5293 | WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2), | |
5294 | }; | |
5295 | ||
5296 | /** | |
5297 | * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags | |
5298 | * | |
5299 | * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed | |
5300 | * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed | |
5301 | * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed | |
5302 | * | |
5303 | */ | |
5304 | enum wiphy_opmode_flag { | |
5305 | STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0), | |
5306 | STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED = BIT(1), | |
5307 | STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED = BIT(2), | |
5308 | }; | |
5309 | ||
5310 | /** | |
5311 | * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information | |
5312 | * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag | |
5313 | * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station | |
5314 | * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station | |
5315 | * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station | |
5316 | */ | |
5317 | ||
5318 | struct sta_opmode_info { | |
5319 | u32 changed; | |
5320 | enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode; | |
5321 | enum nl80211_chan_width bw; | |
5322 | u8 rx_nss; | |
5323 | }; | |
5324 | ||
5325 | #define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA)) | |
5326 | ||
5327 | /** | |
5328 | * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition | |
5329 | * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211 | |
5330 | * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags | |
5331 | * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the | |
5332 | * flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data | |
5333 | * pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all | |
5334 | * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The | |
5335 | * @storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple | |
5336 | * dumpit calls. | |
5337 | * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA. | |
5338 | * Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the | |
5339 | * attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command). | |
5340 | * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy | |
5341 | * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and | |
5342 | * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others | |
5343 | * are used with dump requests. | |
5344 | */ | |
5345 | struct wiphy_vendor_command { | |
5346 | struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info; | |
5347 | u32 flags; | |
5348 | int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
5349 | const void *data, int data_len); | |
5350 | int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
5351 | struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len, | |
5352 | unsigned long *storage); | |
5353 | const struct nla_policy *policy; | |
5354 | unsigned int maxattr; | |
5355 | }; | |
5356 | ||
5357 | /** | |
5358 | * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type | |
5359 | * @iftype: interface type | |
5360 | * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver, | |
5361 | * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the | |
5362 | * 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are | |
5363 | * in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std | |
5364 | * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. | |
5365 | * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values | |
5366 | * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities | |
5367 | * @eml_capabilities: EML capabilities (for MLO) | |
5368 | * @mld_capa_and_ops: MLD capabilities and operations (for MLO) | |
5369 | */ | |
5370 | struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab { | |
5371 | enum nl80211_iftype iftype; | |
5372 | const u8 *extended_capabilities; | |
5373 | const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask; | |
5374 | u8 extended_capabilities_len; | |
5375 | u16 eml_capabilities; | |
5376 | u16 mld_capa_and_ops; | |
5377 | }; | |
5378 | ||
5379 | /** | |
5380 | * cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa - lookup interface type extended capability | |
5381 | * @wiphy: the wiphy to look up from | |
5382 | * @type: the interface type to look up | |
5383 | * | |
5384 | * Return: The extended capability for the given interface @type, may be %NULL | |
5385 | */ | |
5386 | const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab * | |
5387 | cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype type); | |
5388 | ||
5389 | /** | |
5390 | * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities | |
5391 | * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement | |
5392 | * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement | |
5393 | * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement | |
5394 | * @ftm: FTM measurement data | |
5395 | * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported | |
5396 | * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported | |
5397 | * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported | |
5398 | * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data | |
5399 | * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data | |
5400 | * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble) | |
5401 | * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width) | |
5402 | * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported | |
5403 | * (set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily | |
5404 | * forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick) | |
5405 | * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if | |
5406 | * not limited) | |
5407 | * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported | |
5408 | * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported | |
5409 | */ | |
5410 | struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities { | |
5411 | unsigned int max_peers; | |
5412 | u8 report_ap_tsf:1, | |
5413 | randomize_mac_addr:1; | |
5414 | ||
5415 | struct { | |
5416 | u32 preambles; | |
5417 | u32 bandwidths; | |
5418 | s8 max_bursts_exponent; | |
5419 | u8 max_ftms_per_burst; | |
5420 | u8 supported:1, | |
5421 | asap:1, | |
5422 | non_asap:1, | |
5423 | request_lci:1, | |
5424 | request_civicloc:1, | |
5425 | trigger_based:1, | |
5426 | non_trigger_based:1; | |
5427 | } ftm; | |
5428 | }; | |
5429 | ||
5430 | /** | |
5431 | * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm | |
5432 | * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the | |
5433 | * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites. | |
5434 | * | |
5435 | * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types | |
5436 | * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites | |
5437 | * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites | |
5438 | */ | |
5439 | struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites { | |
5440 | u16 iftypes_mask; | |
5441 | const u32 *akm_suites; | |
5442 | int n_akm_suites; | |
5443 | }; | |
5444 | ||
5445 | /** | |
5446 | * struct wiphy_radio_freq_range - wiphy frequency range | |
5447 | * @start_freq: start range edge frequency (kHz) | |
5448 | * @end_freq: end range edge frequency (kHz) | |
5449 | */ | |
5450 | struct wiphy_radio_freq_range { | |
5451 | u32 start_freq; | |
5452 | u32 end_freq; | |
5453 | }; | |
5454 | ||
5455 | ||
5456 | /** | |
5457 | * struct wiphy_radio - physical radio of a wiphy | |
5458 | * This structure describes a physical radio belonging to a wiphy. | |
5459 | * It is used to describe concurrent-channel capabilities. Only one channel | |
5460 | * can be active on the radio described by struct wiphy_radio. | |
5461 | * | |
5462 | * @freq_range: frequency range that the radio can operate on. | |
5463 | * @n_freq_range: number of elements in @freq_range | |
5464 | * | |
5465 | * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not | |
5466 | * list single interface types. | |
5467 | * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array. | |
5468 | * | |
5469 | * @antenna_mask: bitmask of antennas connected to this radio. | |
5470 | */ | |
5471 | struct wiphy_radio { | |
5472 | const struct wiphy_radio_freq_range *freq_range; | |
5473 | int n_freq_range; | |
5474 | ||
5475 | const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations; | |
5476 | int n_iface_combinations; | |
5477 | ||
5478 | u32 antenna_mask; | |
5479 | }; | |
5480 | ||
5481 | #define CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS 0xffff | |
5482 | ||
5483 | /** | |
5484 | * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description | |
5485 | * @mtx: mutex for the data (structures) of this device | |
5486 | * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback, | |
5487 | * note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory() | |
5488 | * the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL | |
5489 | * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via | |
5490 | * the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver | |
5491 | * on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future | |
5492 | * regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers. | |
5493 | * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss. | |
5494 | * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites | |
5495 | * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites | |
5496 | * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if | |
5497 | * the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in | |
5498 | * iftype_akm_suites. | |
5499 | * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites | |
5500 | * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type. | |
5501 | * Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot | |
5502 | * overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all | |
5503 | * instances of iftype_akm_suites). | |
5504 | * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm | |
5505 | * suites are specified separately. | |
5506 | * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit) | |
5507 | * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit) | |
5508 | * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold); | |
5509 | * -1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used | |
5510 | * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled | |
5511 | * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in | |
5512 | * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device | |
5513 | * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking, | |
5514 | * set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last | |
5515 | * four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual | |
5516 | * variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with | |
5517 | * interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up. | |
5518 | * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses. | |
5519 | * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer | |
5520 | * to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used | |
5521 | * by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to | |
5522 | * all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle | |
5523 | * the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses. | |
5524 | * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against | |
5525 | * unregister hardware | |
5526 | * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>). | |
5527 | * It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames | |
5528 | * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in | |
5529 | * /sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev() | |
5530 | * (see below). | |
5531 | * @wext: wireless extension handlers | |
5532 | * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter) | |
5533 | * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy, | |
5534 | * must be set by driver | |
5535 | * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not | |
5536 | * list single interface types. | |
5537 | * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array. | |
5538 | * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not | |
5539 | * subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW. | |
5540 | * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags | |
5541 | * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see | |
5542 | * &enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags | |
5543 | * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags. | |
5544 | * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see | |
5545 | * &enum nl80211_ext_feature_index. | |
5546 | * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it, | |
5547 | * this variable determines its size | |
5548 | * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in | |
5549 | * any given scan | |
5550 | * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that | |
5551 | * the device can run concurrently. | |
5552 | * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan | |
5553 | * for in any given scheduled scan | |
5554 | * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle | |
5555 | * when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not | |
5556 | * supported. | |
5557 | * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can | |
5558 | * add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not | |
5559 | * include fixed IEs like supported rates | |
5560 | * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled | |
5561 | * scans | |
5562 | * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number | |
5563 | * of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device. | |
5564 | * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a | |
5565 | * single scan plan supported by the device. | |
5566 | * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single | |
5567 | * scan plan supported by the device. | |
5568 | * @coverage_class: current coverage class | |
5569 | * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting | |
5570 | * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting | |
5571 | * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device | |
5572 | * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary | |
5573 | * wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers | |
5574 | * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device | |
5575 | * | |
5576 | * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or | |
5577 | * transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface | |
5578 | * type | |
5579 | * | |
5580 | * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be | |
5581 | * configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be | |
5582 | * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set. | |
5583 | * | |
5584 | * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be | |
5585 | * configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be | |
5586 | * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set. | |
5587 | * | |
5588 | * @probe_resp_offload: | |
5589 | * Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading. | |
5590 | * See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid | |
5591 | * when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set. | |
5592 | * | |
5593 | * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation | |
5594 | * may request, if implemented. | |
5595 | * | |
5596 | * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information | |
5597 | * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be | |
5598 | * used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed | |
5599 | * to the suspend() operation instead. | |
5600 | * | |
5601 | * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features. | |
5602 | * @ht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden. | |
5603 | * If null, then none can be over-ridden. | |
5604 | * @vht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden. | |
5605 | * If null, then none can be over-ridden. | |
5606 | * | |
5607 | * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must | |
5608 | * not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection. | |
5609 | * | |
5610 | * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device | |
5611 | * supports for ACL. | |
5612 | * | |
5613 | * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver, | |
5614 | * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are | |
5615 | * the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") | |
5616 | * and are in the same format as in the information element. See | |
5617 | * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default | |
5618 | * extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified | |
5619 | * for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab. | |
5620 | * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values | |
5621 | * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities | |
5622 | * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type | |
5623 | * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended | |
5624 | * capabilities are specified separately. | |
5625 | * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information | |
5626 | * | |
5627 | * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware | |
5628 | * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands | |
5629 | * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware | |
5630 | * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events | |
5631 | * | |
5632 | * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode | |
5633 | * (including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The | |
5634 | * driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in | |
5635 | * some cases, but may not always reach. | |
5636 | * | |
5637 | * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons | |
5638 | * and probe responses. This value should be set if the driver | |
5639 | * wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means | |
5640 | * infinite. | |
5641 | * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported | |
5642 | * by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the | |
5643 | * attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr. | |
5644 | * | |
5645 | * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a | |
5646 | * bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values. For instance, for | |
5647 | * NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set | |
5648 | * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)). | |
5649 | * | |
5650 | * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit | |
5651 | * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit | |
5652 | * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum | |
5653 | * | |
5654 | * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using | |
5655 | * wake_tx_queue | |
5656 | * | |
5657 | * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP | |
5658 | * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not | |
5659 | * HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues. | |
5660 | * @support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect. | |
5661 | * | |
5662 | * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities | |
5663 | * | |
5664 | * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the | |
5665 | * device has | |
5666 | * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations) | |
5667 | * supported by the driver for each vif | |
5668 | * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations) | |
5669 | * supported by the driver for each peer | |
5670 | * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for | |
5671 | * long/short retry configuration | |
5672 | * | |
5673 | * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for | |
5674 | * configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and | |
5675 | * %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes | |
5676 | * @sar_capa: SAR control capabilities | |
5677 | * @rfkill: a pointer to the rfkill structure | |
5678 | * | |
5679 | * @mbssid_max_interfaces: maximum number of interfaces supported by the driver | |
5680 | * in a multiple BSSID set. This field must be set to a non-zero value | |
5681 | * by the driver to advertise MBSSID support. | |
5682 | * @ema_max_profile_periodicity: maximum profile periodicity supported by | |
5683 | * the driver. Setting this field to a non-zero value indicates that the | |
5684 | * driver supports enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP). | |
5685 | * @max_num_akm_suites: maximum number of AKM suites allowed for | |
5686 | * configuration through %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and | |
5687 | * %NL80211_CMD_START_AP. Set to NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES if not set by | |
5688 | * driver. If set by driver minimum allowed value is | |
5689 | * NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES in order to avoid compatibility issues with | |
5690 | * legacy userspace and maximum allowed value is | |
5691 | * CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES. | |
5692 | * | |
5693 | * @hw_timestamp_max_peers: maximum number of peers that the driver supports | |
5694 | * enabling HW timestamping for concurrently. Setting this field to a | |
5695 | * non-zero value indicates that the driver supports HW timestamping. | |
5696 | * A value of %CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS indicates the driver | |
5697 | * supports enabling HW timestamping for all peers (i.e. no need to | |
5698 | * specify a mac address). | |
5699 | * | |
5700 | * @radio: radios belonging to this wiphy | |
5701 | * @n_radio: number of radios | |
5702 | */ | |
5703 | struct wiphy { | |
5704 | struct mutex mtx; | |
5705 | ||
5706 | /* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */ | |
5707 | ||
5708 | u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN]; | |
5709 | u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN]; | |
5710 | ||
5711 | struct mac_address *addresses; | |
5712 | ||
5713 | const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes; | |
5714 | ||
5715 | const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations; | |
5716 | int n_iface_combinations; | |
5717 | u16 software_iftypes; | |
5718 | ||
5719 | u16 n_addresses; | |
5720 | ||
5721 | /* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */ | |
5722 | u16 interface_modes; | |
5723 | ||
5724 | u16 max_acl_mac_addrs; | |
5725 | ||
5726 | u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features; | |
5727 | u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)]; | |
5728 | ||
5729 | u32 ap_sme_capa; | |
5730 | ||
5731 | enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type; | |
5732 | ||
5733 | int bss_priv_size; | |
5734 | u8 max_scan_ssids; | |
5735 | u8 max_sched_scan_reqs; | |
5736 | u8 max_sched_scan_ssids; | |
5737 | u8 max_match_sets; | |
5738 | u16 max_scan_ie_len; | |
5739 | u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len; | |
5740 | u32 max_sched_scan_plans; | |
5741 | u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval; | |
5742 | u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations; | |
5743 | ||
5744 | int n_cipher_suites; | |
5745 | const u32 *cipher_suites; | |
5746 | ||
5747 | int n_akm_suites; | |
5748 | const u32 *akm_suites; | |
5749 | ||
5750 | const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites; | |
5751 | unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites; | |
5752 | ||
5753 | u8 retry_short; | |
5754 | u8 retry_long; | |
5755 | u32 frag_threshold; | |
5756 | u32 rts_threshold; | |
5757 | u8 coverage_class; | |
5758 | ||
5759 | char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN]; | |
5760 | u32 hw_version; | |
5761 | ||
5762 | #ifdef CONFIG_PM | |
5763 | const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan; | |
5764 | struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config; | |
5765 | #endif | |
5766 | ||
5767 | u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration; | |
5768 | ||
5769 | u8 max_num_pmkids; | |
5770 | ||
5771 | u32 available_antennas_tx; | |
5772 | u32 available_antennas_rx; | |
5773 | ||
5774 | u32 probe_resp_offload; | |
5775 | ||
5776 | const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask; | |
5777 | u8 extended_capabilities_len; | |
5778 | ||
5779 | const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab; | |
5780 | unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab; | |
5781 | ||
5782 | const void *privid; | |
5783 | ||
5784 | struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; | |
5785 | ||
5786 | void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
5787 | struct regulatory_request *request); | |
5788 | ||
5789 | /* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */ | |
5790 | ||
5791 | const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd; | |
5792 | ||
5793 | struct device dev; | |
5794 | ||
5795 | bool registered; | |
5796 | ||
5797 | struct dentry *debugfsdir; | |
5798 | ||
5799 | const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask; | |
5800 | const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask; | |
5801 | ||
5802 | struct list_head wdev_list; | |
5803 | ||
5804 | possible_net_t _net; | |
5805 | ||
5806 | #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT | |
5807 | const struct iw_handler_def *wext; | |
5808 | #endif | |
5809 | ||
5810 | const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce; | |
5811 | ||
5812 | const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands; | |
5813 | const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events; | |
5814 | int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events; | |
5815 | ||
5816 | u16 max_ap_assoc_sta; | |
5817 | ||
5818 | u8 max_num_csa_counters; | |
5819 | ||
5820 | u32 bss_select_support; | |
5821 | ||
5822 | u8 nan_supported_bands; | |
5823 | ||
5824 | u32 txq_limit; | |
5825 | u32 txq_memory_limit; | |
5826 | u32 txq_quantum; | |
5827 | ||
5828 | unsigned long tx_queue_len; | |
5829 | ||
5830 | u8 support_mbssid:1, | |
5831 | support_only_he_mbssid:1; | |
5832 | ||
5833 | const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa; | |
5834 | ||
5835 | struct { | |
5836 | u64 peer, vif; | |
5837 | u8 max_retry; | |
5838 | } tid_config_support; | |
5839 | ||
5840 | u8 max_data_retry_count; | |
5841 | ||
5842 | const struct cfg80211_sar_capa *sar_capa; | |
5843 | ||
5844 | struct rfkill *rfkill; | |
5845 | ||
5846 | u8 mbssid_max_interfaces; | |
5847 | u8 ema_max_profile_periodicity; | |
5848 | u16 max_num_akm_suites; | |
5849 | ||
5850 | u16 hw_timestamp_max_peers; | |
5851 | ||
5852 | int n_radio; | |
5853 | const struct wiphy_radio *radio; | |
5854 | ||
5855 | char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN); | |
5856 | }; | |
5857 | ||
5858 | static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy) | |
5859 | { | |
5860 | return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net); | |
5861 | } | |
5862 | ||
5863 | static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net) | |
5864 | { | |
5865 | write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net); | |
5866 | } | |
5867 | ||
5868 | /** | |
5869 | * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy | |
5870 | * | |
5871 | * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return | |
5872 | * Return: The priv of @wiphy. | |
5873 | */ | |
5874 | static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy) | |
5875 | { | |
5876 | BUG_ON(!wiphy); | |
5877 | return &wiphy->priv; | |
5878 | } | |
5879 | ||
5880 | /** | |
5881 | * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv | |
5882 | * | |
5883 | * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv | |
5884 | * Return: The wiphy of @priv. | |
5885 | */ | |
5886 | static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv) | |
5887 | { | |
5888 | BUG_ON(!priv); | |
5889 | return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv); | |
5890 | } | |
5891 | ||
5892 | /** | |
5893 | * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy | |
5894 | * | |
5895 | * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind | |
5896 | * @dev: The device to parent it to | |
5897 | */ | |
5898 | static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev) | |
5899 | { | |
5900 | wiphy->dev.parent = dev; | |
5901 | } | |
5902 | ||
5903 | /** | |
5904 | * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer | |
5905 | * | |
5906 | * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up | |
5907 | * Return: The dev of @wiphy. | |
5908 | */ | |
5909 | static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy) | |
5910 | { | |
5911 | return wiphy->dev.parent; | |
5912 | } | |
5913 | ||
5914 | /** | |
5915 | * wiphy_name - get wiphy name | |
5916 | * | |
5917 | * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return | |
5918 | * Return: The name of @wiphy. | |
5919 | */ | |
5920 | static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy) | |
5921 | { | |
5922 | return dev_name(&wiphy->dev); | |
5923 | } | |
5924 | ||
5925 | /** | |
5926 | * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211 | |
5927 | * | |
5928 | * @ops: The configuration operations for this device | |
5929 | * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate | |
5930 | * @requested_name: Request a particular name. | |
5931 | * NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming. | |
5932 | * | |
5933 | * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it. | |
5934 | * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use. | |
5935 | * | |
5936 | * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be | |
5937 | * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation. | |
5938 | */ | |
5939 | struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv, | |
5940 | const char *requested_name); | |
5941 | ||
5942 | /** | |
5943 | * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211 | |
5944 | * | |
5945 | * @ops: The configuration operations for this device | |
5946 | * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate | |
5947 | * | |
5948 | * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it. | |
5949 | * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use. | |
5950 | * | |
5951 | * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be | |
5952 | * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation. | |
5953 | */ | |
5954 | static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, | |
5955 | int sizeof_priv) | |
5956 | { | |
5957 | return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL); | |
5958 | } | |
5959 | ||
5960 | /** | |
5961 | * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211 | |
5962 | * | |
5963 | * @wiphy: The wiphy to register. | |
5964 | * | |
5965 | * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code. | |
5966 | */ | |
5967 | int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy); | |
5968 | ||
5969 | /* this is a define for better error reporting (file/line) */ | |
5970 | #define lockdep_assert_wiphy(wiphy) lockdep_assert_held(&(wiphy)->mtx) | |
5971 | ||
5972 | /** | |
5973 | * rcu_dereference_wiphy - rcu_dereference with debug checking | |
5974 | * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on | |
5975 | * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing | |
5976 | * | |
5977 | * Do an rcu_dereference(p), but check caller either holds rcu_read_lock() | |
5978 | * or RTNL. Note: Please prefer wiphy_dereference() or rcu_dereference(). | |
5979 | */ | |
5980 | #define rcu_dereference_wiphy(wiphy, p) \ | |
5981 | rcu_dereference_check(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx)) | |
5982 | ||
5983 | /** | |
5984 | * wiphy_dereference - fetch RCU pointer when updates are prevented by wiphy mtx | |
5985 | * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on | |
5986 | * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing | |
5987 | * | |
5988 | * Return: the value of the specified RCU-protected pointer, but omit the | |
5989 | * READ_ONCE(), because caller holds the wiphy mutex used for updates. | |
5990 | */ | |
5991 | #define wiphy_dereference(wiphy, p) \ | |
5992 | rcu_dereference_protected(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx)) | |
5993 | ||
5994 | /** | |
5995 | * get_wiphy_regdom - get custom regdomain for the given wiphy | |
5996 | * @wiphy: the wiphy to get the regdomain from | |
5997 | * | |
5998 | * Context: Requires any of RTNL, wiphy mutex or RCU protection. | |
5999 | * | |
6000 | * Return: pointer to the regulatory domain associated with the wiphy | |
6001 | */ | |
6002 | const struct ieee80211_regdomain *get_wiphy_regdom(struct wiphy *wiphy); | |
6003 | ||
6004 | /** | |
6005 | * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211 | |
6006 | * | |
6007 | * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister. | |
6008 | * | |
6009 | * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv | |
6010 | * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding | |
6011 | * request that is being handled. | |
6012 | */ | |
6013 | void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy); | |
6014 | ||
6015 | /** | |
6016 | * wiphy_free - free wiphy | |
6017 | * | |
6018 | * @wiphy: The wiphy to free | |
6019 | */ | |
6020 | void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy); | |
6021 | ||
6022 | /* internal structs */ | |
6023 | struct cfg80211_conn; | |
6024 | struct cfg80211_internal_bss; | |
6025 | struct cfg80211_cached_keys; | |
6026 | struct cfg80211_cqm_config; | |
6027 | ||
6028 | /** | |
6029 | * wiphy_lock - lock the wiphy | |
6030 | * @wiphy: the wiphy to lock | |
6031 | * | |
6032 | * This is needed around registering and unregistering netdevs that | |
6033 | * aren't created through cfg80211 calls, since that requires locking | |
6034 | * in cfg80211 when the notifiers is called, but that cannot | |
6035 | * differentiate which way it's called. | |
6036 | * | |
6037 | * It can also be used by drivers for their own purposes. | |
6038 | * | |
6039 | * When cfg80211 ops are called, the wiphy is already locked. | |
6040 | * | |
6041 | * Note that this makes sure that no workers that have been queued | |
6042 | * with wiphy_queue_work() are running. | |
6043 | */ | |
6044 | static inline void wiphy_lock(struct wiphy *wiphy) | |
6045 | __acquires(&wiphy->mtx) | |
6046 | { | |
6047 | mutex_lock(&wiphy->mtx); | |
6048 | __acquire(&wiphy->mtx); | |
6049 | } | |
6050 | ||
6051 | /** | |
6052 | * wiphy_unlock - unlock the wiphy again | |
6053 | * @wiphy: the wiphy to unlock | |
6054 | */ | |
6055 | static inline void wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy *wiphy) | |
6056 | __releases(&wiphy->mtx) | |
6057 | { | |
6058 | __release(&wiphy->mtx); | |
6059 | mutex_unlock(&wiphy->mtx); | |
6060 | } | |
6061 | ||
6062 | DEFINE_GUARD(wiphy, struct wiphy *, | |
6063 | mutex_lock(&_T->mtx), | |
6064 | mutex_unlock(&_T->mtx)) | |
6065 | ||
6066 | struct wiphy_work; | |
6067 | typedef void (*wiphy_work_func_t)(struct wiphy *, struct wiphy_work *); | |
6068 | ||
6069 | struct wiphy_work { | |
6070 | struct list_head entry; | |
6071 | wiphy_work_func_t func; | |
6072 | }; | |
6073 | ||
6074 | static inline void wiphy_work_init(struct wiphy_work *work, | |
6075 | wiphy_work_func_t func) | |
6076 | { | |
6077 | INIT_LIST_HEAD(&work->entry); | |
6078 | work->func = func; | |
6079 | } | |
6080 | ||
6081 | /** | |
6082 | * wiphy_work_queue - queue work for the wiphy | |
6083 | * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for | |
6084 | * @work: the work item | |
6085 | * | |
6086 | * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work | |
6087 | * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be | |
6088 | * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running | |
6089 | * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can | |
6090 | * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires | |
6091 | * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock(). | |
6092 | */ | |
6093 | void wiphy_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work); | |
6094 | ||
6095 | /** | |
6096 | * wiphy_work_cancel - cancel previously queued work | |
6097 | * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes | |
6098 | * @work: the work to cancel | |
6099 | * | |
6100 | * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being | |
6101 | * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock(). | |
6102 | */ | |
6103 | void wiphy_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work); | |
6104 | ||
6105 | /** | |
6106 | * wiphy_work_flush - flush previously queued work | |
6107 | * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes | |
6108 | * @work: the work to flush, this can be %NULL to flush all work | |
6109 | * | |
6110 | * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called | |
6111 | * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock(). | |
6112 | */ | |
6113 | void wiphy_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work); | |
6114 | ||
6115 | struct wiphy_delayed_work { | |
6116 | struct wiphy_work work; | |
6117 | struct wiphy *wiphy; | |
6118 | struct timer_list timer; | |
6119 | }; | |
6120 | ||
6121 | void wiphy_delayed_work_timer(struct timer_list *t); | |
6122 | ||
6123 | static inline void wiphy_delayed_work_init(struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork, | |
6124 | wiphy_work_func_t func) | |
6125 | { | |
6126 | timer_setup(&dwork->timer, wiphy_delayed_work_timer, 0); | |
6127 | wiphy_work_init(&dwork->work, func); | |
6128 | } | |
6129 | ||
6130 | /** | |
6131 | * wiphy_delayed_work_queue - queue delayed work for the wiphy | |
6132 | * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for | |
6133 | * @dwork: the delayable worker | |
6134 | * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing | |
6135 | * | |
6136 | * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work | |
6137 | * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be | |
6138 | * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running | |
6139 | * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can | |
6140 | * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires | |
6141 | * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock(). | |
6142 | */ | |
6143 | void wiphy_delayed_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
6144 | struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork, | |
6145 | unsigned long delay); | |
6146 | ||
6147 | /** | |
6148 | * wiphy_delayed_work_cancel - cancel previously queued delayed work | |
6149 | * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes | |
6150 | * @dwork: the delayed work to cancel | |
6151 | * | |
6152 | * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being | |
6153 | * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock(). | |
6154 | */ | |
6155 | void wiphy_delayed_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
6156 | struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork); | |
6157 | ||
6158 | /** | |
6159 | * wiphy_delayed_work_flush - flush previously queued delayed work | |
6160 | * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes | |
6161 | * @dwork: the delayed work to flush | |
6162 | * | |
6163 | * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called | |
6164 | * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock(). | |
6165 | */ | |
6166 | void wiphy_delayed_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
6167 | struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork); | |
6168 | ||
6169 | /** | |
6170 | * wiphy_delayed_work_pending - Find out whether a wiphy delayable | |
6171 | * work item is currently pending. | |
6172 | * | |
6173 | * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes | |
6174 | * @dwork: the delayed work in question | |
6175 | * | |
6176 | * Return: true if timer is pending, false otherwise | |
6177 | * | |
6178 | * How wiphy_delayed_work_queue() works is by setting a timer which | |
6179 | * when it expires calls wiphy_work_queue() to queue the wiphy work. | |
6180 | * Because wiphy_delayed_work_queue() uses mod_timer(), if it is | |
6181 | * called twice and the second call happens before the first call | |
6182 | * deadline, the work will rescheduled for the second deadline and | |
6183 | * won't run before that. | |
6184 | * | |
6185 | * wiphy_delayed_work_pending() can be used to detect if calling | |
6186 | * wiphy_work_delayed_work_queue() would start a new work schedule | |
6187 | * or delayed a previous one. As seen below it cannot be used to | |
6188 | * detect precisely if the work has finished to execute nor if it | |
6189 | * is currently executing. | |
6190 | * | |
6191 | * CPU0 CPU1 | |
6192 | * wiphy_delayed_work_queue(wk) | |
6193 | * mod_timer(wk->timer) | |
6194 | * wiphy_delayed_work_pending(wk) -> true | |
6195 | * | |
6196 | * [...] | |
6197 | * expire_timers(wk->timer) | |
6198 | * detach_timer(wk->timer) | |
6199 | * wiphy_delayed_work_pending(wk) -> false | |
6200 | * wk->timer->function() | | |
6201 | * wiphy_work_queue(wk) | delayed work pending | |
6202 | * list_add_tail() | returns false but | |
6203 | * queue_work(cfg80211_wiphy_work) | wk->func() has not | |
6204 | * | been run yet | |
6205 | * [...] | | |
6206 | * cfg80211_wiphy_work() | | |
6207 | * wk->func() V | |
6208 | * | |
6209 | */ | |
6210 | bool wiphy_delayed_work_pending(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
6211 | struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork); | |
6212 | ||
6213 | /** | |
6214 | * enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power - regulatory power for an Access Point | |
6215 | * | |
6216 | * @IEEE80211_REG_UNSET_AP: Access Point has no regulatory power mode | |
6217 | * @IEEE80211_REG_LPI_AP: Indoor Access Point | |
6218 | * @IEEE80211_REG_SP_AP: Standard power Access Point | |
6219 | * @IEEE80211_REG_VLP_AP: Very low power Access Point | |
6220 | */ | |
6221 | enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power { | |
6222 | IEEE80211_REG_UNSET_AP, | |
6223 | IEEE80211_REG_LPI_AP, | |
6224 | IEEE80211_REG_SP_AP, | |
6225 | IEEE80211_REG_VLP_AP, | |
6226 | }; | |
6227 | ||
6228 | /** | |
6229 | * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state | |
6230 | * | |
6231 | * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver | |
6232 | * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this | |
6233 | * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.) | |
6234 | * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will | |
6235 | * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device, | |
6236 | * however, drivers must lock the wiphy before registering or | |
6237 | * unregistering netdevs if they pre-create any netdevs (in ops | |
6238 | * called from cfg80211, the wiphy is already locked.) | |
6239 | * | |
6240 | * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver | |
6241 | * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as | |
6242 | * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be | |
6243 | * allocated outside of callback operations that return it. | |
6244 | * | |
6245 | * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description | |
6246 | * @iftype: interface type | |
6247 | * @registered: is this wdev already registered with cfg80211 | |
6248 | * @registering: indicates we're doing registration under wiphy lock | |
6249 | * for the notifier | |
6250 | * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces | |
6251 | * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL | |
6252 | * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this | |
6253 | * wireless device if it has no netdev | |
6254 | * @u: union containing data specific to @iftype | |
6255 | * @connected: indicates if connected or not (STA mode) | |
6256 | * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code | |
6257 | * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling | |
6258 | * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data | |
6259 | * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data | |
6260 | * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association | |
6261 | * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements | |
6262 | * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID | |
6263 | * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID | |
6264 | * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index | |
6265 | * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index | |
6266 | * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation | |
6267 | * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity | |
6268 | * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be | |
6269 | * set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the | |
6270 | * netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update | |
6271 | * by cfg80211 on change_interface | |
6272 | * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames | |
6273 | * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated, | |
6274 | * need to propagate the update to the driver | |
6275 | * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL | |
6276 | * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g. | |
6277 | * the P2P Device. | |
6278 | * @ps: powersave mode is enabled | |
6279 | * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout | |
6280 | * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application | |
6281 | * registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode) | |
6282 | * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data | |
6283 | * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established | |
6284 | * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type | |
6285 | * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID | |
6286 | * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work | |
6287 | * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect | |
6288 | * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing | |
6289 | * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list | |
6290 | * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID | |
6291 | * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away | |
6292 | * @cqm_rssi_work: (private) CQM RSSI reporting work | |
6293 | * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state | |
6294 | * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests | |
6295 | * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock | |
6296 | * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work | |
6297 | * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last | |
6298 | * unprotected beacon report | |
6299 | * @links: array of %IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS elements containing @addr | |
6300 | * @ap and @client for each link | |
6301 | * @links.cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been | |
6302 | * started | |
6303 | * @links.cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was | |
6304 | * entered. | |
6305 | * @links.cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms | |
6306 | * @valid_links: bitmap describing what elements of @links are valid | |
6307 | * @radio_mask: Bitmask of radios that this interface is allowed to operate on. | |
6308 | */ | |
6309 | struct wireless_dev { | |
6310 | struct wiphy *wiphy; | |
6311 | enum nl80211_iftype iftype; | |
6312 | ||
6313 | /* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */ | |
6314 | struct list_head list; | |
6315 | struct net_device *netdev; | |
6316 | ||
6317 | u32 identifier; | |
6318 | ||
6319 | struct list_head mgmt_registrations; | |
6320 | u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1; | |
6321 | ||
6322 | bool use_4addr, is_running, registered, registering; | |
6323 | ||
6324 | u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16)); | |
6325 | ||
6326 | /* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */ | |
6327 | struct cfg80211_conn *conn; | |
6328 | struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys; | |
6329 | enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type; | |
6330 | u32 conn_owner_nlportid; | |
6331 | ||
6332 | struct work_struct disconnect_wk; | |
6333 | u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN]; | |
6334 | ||
6335 | struct list_head event_list; | |
6336 | spinlock_t event_lock; | |
6337 | ||
6338 | u8 connected:1; | |
6339 | ||
6340 | bool ps; | |
6341 | int ps_timeout; | |
6342 | ||
6343 | u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid; | |
6344 | ||
6345 | u32 owner_nlportid; | |
6346 | bool nl_owner_dead; | |
6347 | ||
6348 | #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT | |
6349 | /* wext data */ | |
6350 | struct { | |
6351 | struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss; | |
6352 | struct cfg80211_connect_params connect; | |
6353 | struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys; | |
6354 | const u8 *ie; | |
6355 | size_t ie_len; | |
6356 | u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; | |
6357 | u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN]; | |
6358 | u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; | |
6359 | s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key; | |
6360 | bool prev_bssid_valid; | |
6361 | } wext; | |
6362 | #endif | |
6363 | ||
6364 | struct wiphy_work cqm_rssi_work; | |
6365 | struct cfg80211_cqm_config __rcu *cqm_config; | |
6366 | ||
6367 | struct list_head pmsr_list; | |
6368 | spinlock_t pmsr_lock; | |
6369 | struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk; | |
6370 | ||
6371 | unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported; | |
6372 | ||
6373 | union { | |
6374 | struct { | |
6375 | u8 connected_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | |
6376 | u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; | |
6377 | u8 ssid_len; | |
6378 | } client; | |
6379 | struct { | |
6380 | int beacon_interval; | |
6381 | struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef; | |
6382 | struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; | |
6383 | u8 id[IEEE80211_MAX_MESH_ID_LEN]; | |
6384 | u8 id_len, id_up_len; | |
6385 | } mesh; | |
6386 | struct { | |
6387 | struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef; | |
6388 | u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; | |
6389 | u8 ssid_len; | |
6390 | } ap; | |
6391 | struct { | |
6392 | struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss; | |
6393 | struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; | |
6394 | int beacon_interval; | |
6395 | u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; | |
6396 | u8 ssid_len; | |
6397 | } ibss; | |
6398 | struct { | |
6399 | struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; | |
6400 | } ocb; | |
6401 | } u; | |
6402 | ||
6403 | struct { | |
6404 | u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | |
6405 | union { | |
6406 | struct { | |
6407 | unsigned int beacon_interval; | |
6408 | struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; | |
6409 | } ap; | |
6410 | struct { | |
6411 | struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss; | |
6412 | } client; | |
6413 | }; | |
6414 | ||
6415 | bool cac_started; | |
6416 | unsigned long cac_start_time; | |
6417 | unsigned int cac_time_ms; | |
6418 | } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; | |
6419 | u16 valid_links; | |
6420 | ||
6421 | u32 radio_mask; | |
6422 | }; | |
6423 | ||
6424 | static inline const u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev) | |
6425 | { | |
6426 | if (wdev->netdev) | |
6427 | return wdev->netdev->dev_addr; | |
6428 | return wdev->address; | |
6429 | } | |
6430 | ||
6431 | static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev) | |
6432 | { | |
6433 | if (wdev->netdev) | |
6434 | return netif_running(wdev->netdev); | |
6435 | return wdev->is_running; | |
6436 | } | |
6437 | ||
6438 | /** | |
6439 | * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev | |
6440 | * | |
6441 | * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return | |
6442 | * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev. | |
6443 | */ | |
6444 | static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev) | |
6445 | { | |
6446 | BUG_ON(!wdev); | |
6447 | return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy); | |
6448 | } | |
6449 | ||
6450 | /** | |
6451 | * wdev_chandef - return chandef pointer from wireless_dev | |
6452 | * @wdev: the wdev | |
6453 | * @link_id: the link ID for MLO | |
6454 | * | |
6455 | * Return: The chandef depending on the mode, or %NULL. | |
6456 | */ | |
6457 | struct cfg80211_chan_def *wdev_chandef(struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
6458 | unsigned int link_id); | |
6459 | ||
6460 | static inline void WARN_INVALID_LINK_ID(struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
6461 | unsigned int link_id) | |
6462 | { | |
6463 | WARN_ON(link_id && !wdev->valid_links); | |
6464 | WARN_ON(wdev->valid_links && | |
6465 | !(wdev->valid_links & BIT(link_id))); | |
6466 | } | |
6467 | ||
6468 | #define for_each_valid_link(link_info, link_id) \ | |
6469 | for (link_id = 0; \ | |
6470 | link_id < ((link_info)->valid_links ? \ | |
6471 | ARRAY_SIZE((link_info)->links) : 1); \ | |
6472 | link_id++) \ | |
6473 | if (!(link_info)->valid_links || \ | |
6474 | ((link_info)->valid_links & BIT(link_id))) | |
6475 | ||
6476 | /** | |
6477 | * DOC: Utility functions | |
6478 | * | |
6479 | * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful. | |
6480 | */ | |
6481 | ||
6482 | /** | |
6483 | * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel | |
6484 | * | |
6485 | * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel | |
6486 | * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel | |
6487 | * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b | |
6488 | */ | |
6489 | static inline bool | |
6490 | ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a, | |
6491 | struct ieee80211_channel *b) | |
6492 | { | |
6493 | return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq && | |
6494 | a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset); | |
6495 | } | |
6496 | ||
6497 | /** | |
6498 | * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz | |
6499 | * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert | |
6500 | * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz) | |
6501 | */ | |
6502 | static inline u32 | |
6503 | ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan) | |
6504 | { | |
6505 | return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset; | |
6506 | } | |
6507 | ||
6508 | /** | |
6509 | * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan | |
6510 | * | |
6511 | * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ | |
6512 | * @chan: channel | |
6513 | * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq | |
6514 | */ | |
6515 | enum nl80211_chan_width | |
6516 | ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan); | |
6517 | ||
6518 | /** | |
6519 | * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency | |
6520 | * @chan: channel number | |
6521 | * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap | |
6522 | * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed. | |
6523 | */ | |
6524 | u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band); | |
6525 | ||
6526 | /** | |
6527 | * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency | |
6528 | * @chan: channel number | |
6529 | * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap | |
6530 | * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed. | |
6531 | */ | |
6532 | static inline int | |
6533 | ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band) | |
6534 | { | |
6535 | return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band)); | |
6536 | } | |
6537 | ||
6538 | /** | |
6539 | * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number | |
6540 | * @freq: center frequency in KHz | |
6541 | * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed. | |
6542 | */ | |
6543 | int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq); | |
6544 | ||
6545 | /** | |
6546 | * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number | |
6547 | * @freq: center frequency in MHz | |
6548 | * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed. | |
6549 | */ | |
6550 | static inline int | |
6551 | ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq) | |
6552 | { | |
6553 | return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq)); | |
6554 | } | |
6555 | ||
6556 | /** | |
6557 | * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified | |
6558 | * frequency | |
6559 | * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for | |
6560 | * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel | |
6561 | * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq. | |
6562 | */ | |
6563 | struct ieee80211_channel * | |
6564 | ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq); | |
6565 | ||
6566 | /** | |
6567 | * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency | |
6568 | * | |
6569 | * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for | |
6570 | * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel | |
6571 | * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq. | |
6572 | */ | |
6573 | static inline struct ieee80211_channel * | |
6574 | ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq) | |
6575 | { | |
6576 | return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq)); | |
6577 | } | |
6578 | ||
6579 | /** | |
6580 | * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC | |
6581 | * @chan: control channel to check | |
6582 | * | |
6583 | * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in | |
6584 | * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3 | |
6585 | * | |
6586 | * Return: %true if channel is a PSC, %false otherwise | |
6587 | */ | |
6588 | static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan) | |
6589 | { | |
6590 | if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ) | |
6591 | return false; | |
6592 | ||
6593 | return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5; | |
6594 | } | |
6595 | ||
6596 | /** | |
6597 | * cfg80211_radio_chandef_valid - Check if the radio supports the chandef | |
6598 | * | |
6599 | * @radio: wiphy radio | |
6600 | * @chandef: chandef for current channel | |
6601 | * | |
6602 | * Return: whether or not the given chandef is valid for the given radio | |
6603 | */ | |
6604 | bool cfg80211_radio_chandef_valid(const struct wiphy_radio *radio, | |
6605 | const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); | |
6606 | ||
6607 | /** | |
6608 | * cfg80211_wdev_channel_allowed - Check if the wdev may use the channel | |
6609 | * | |
6610 | * @wdev: the wireless device | |
6611 | * @chan: channel to check | |
6612 | * | |
6613 | * Return: whether or not the wdev may use the channel | |
6614 | */ | |
6615 | bool cfg80211_wdev_channel_allowed(struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
6616 | struct ieee80211_channel *chan); | |
6617 | ||
6618 | /** | |
6619 | * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate | |
6620 | * | |
6621 | * @sband: the band to look for rates in | |
6622 | * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates | |
6623 | * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate | |
6624 | * | |
6625 | * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that | |
6626 | * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map, | |
6627 | * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of | |
6628 | * rates in the band's bitrate table. | |
6629 | */ | |
6630 | const struct ieee80211_rate * | |
6631 | ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, | |
6632 | u32 basic_rates, int bitrate); | |
6633 | ||
6634 | /** | |
6635 | * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band | |
6636 | * @sband: the band to look for rates in | |
6637 | * | |
6638 | * Return: a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given band, bits | |
6639 | * are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array. | |
6640 | */ | |
6641 | u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband); | |
6642 | ||
6643 | /* | |
6644 | * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support | |
6645 | * | |
6646 | * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c | |
6647 | * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst | |
6648 | */ | |
6649 | ||
6650 | struct radiotap_align_size { | |
6651 | uint8_t align:4, size:4; | |
6652 | }; | |
6653 | ||
6654 | struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace { | |
6655 | const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size; | |
6656 | int n_bits; | |
6657 | uint32_t oui; | |
6658 | uint8_t subns; | |
6659 | }; | |
6660 | ||
6661 | struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces { | |
6662 | const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns; | |
6663 | int n_ns; | |
6664 | }; | |
6665 | ||
6666 | /** | |
6667 | * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args | |
6668 | * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call | |
6669 | * to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() | |
6670 | * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each | |
6671 | * call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after | |
6672 | * ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to | |
6673 | * the beginning of the actual data portion | |
6674 | * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience | |
6675 | * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition | |
6676 | * (or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown) | |
6677 | * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default | |
6678 | * radiotap namespace or not | |
6679 | * | |
6680 | * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through | |
6681 | * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering | |
6682 | * @_arg_index: next argument index | |
6683 | * @_arg: next argument pointer | |
6684 | * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32 | |
6685 | * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present | |
6686 | * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions | |
6687 | * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data | |
6688 | * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the | |
6689 | * next bitmap word | |
6690 | * | |
6691 | * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore | |
6692 | * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally. | |
6693 | */ | |
6694 | ||
6695 | struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator { | |
6696 | struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader; | |
6697 | const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns; | |
6698 | const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace; | |
6699 | ||
6700 | unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data; | |
6701 | __le32 *_next_bitmap; | |
6702 | ||
6703 | unsigned char *this_arg; | |
6704 | int this_arg_index; | |
6705 | int this_arg_size; | |
6706 | ||
6707 | int is_radiotap_ns; | |
6708 | ||
6709 | int _max_length; | |
6710 | int _arg_index; | |
6711 | uint32_t _bitmap_shifter; | |
6712 | int _reset_on_ext; | |
6713 | }; | |
6714 | ||
6715 | int | |
6716 | ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator, | |
6717 | struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header, | |
6718 | int max_length, | |
6719 | const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns); | |
6720 | ||
6721 | int | |
6722 | ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator); | |
6723 | ||
6724 | ||
6725 | extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6]; | |
6726 | extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6]; | |
6727 | ||
6728 | /** | |
6729 | * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data | |
6730 | * | |
6731 | * @skb: the frame | |
6732 | * | |
6733 | * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function | |
6734 | * returns the 802.11 header length. | |
6735 | * | |
6736 | * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption | |
6737 | * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid | |
6738 | * 802.11 header. | |
6739 | */ | |
6740 | unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb); | |
6741 | ||
6742 | /** | |
6743 | * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control | |
6744 | * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format | |
6745 | * Return: The header length in bytes. | |
6746 | */ | |
6747 | unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc); | |
6748 | ||
6749 | /** | |
6750 | * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length | |
6751 | * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field | |
6752 | * (first byte) will be accessed | |
6753 | * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at | |
6754 | * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present. | |
6755 | */ | |
6756 | unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr); | |
6757 | ||
6758 | /** | |
6759 | * DOC: Data path helpers | |
6760 | * | |
6761 | * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers | |
6762 | * functions that help implement the data path for devices | |
6763 | * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device. | |
6764 | */ | |
6765 | ||
6766 | /** | |
6767 | * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3 | |
6768 | * @skb: the 802.11 data frame | |
6769 | * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead | |
6770 | * of it being pushed into the SKB | |
6771 | * @addr: the device MAC address | |
6772 | * @iftype: the virtual interface type | |
6773 | * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header | |
6774 | * @is_amsdu: true if the 802.11 header is A-MSDU | |
6775 | * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. | |
6776 | */ | |
6777 | int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr, | |
6778 | const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, | |
6779 | u8 data_offset, bool is_amsdu); | |
6780 | ||
6781 | /** | |
6782 | * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3 | |
6783 | * @skb: the 802.11 data frame | |
6784 | * @addr: the device MAC address | |
6785 | * @iftype: the virtual interface type | |
6786 | * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. | |
6787 | */ | |
6788 | static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr, | |
6789 | enum nl80211_iftype iftype) | |
6790 | { | |
6791 | return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0, false); | |
6792 | } | |
6793 | ||
6794 | /** | |
6795 | * ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu - check if subframe lengths of an A-MSDU are valid | |
6796 | * | |
6797 | * This is used to detect non-standard A-MSDU frames, e.g. the ones generated | |
6798 | * by ath10k and ath11k, where the subframe length includes the length of the | |
6799 | * mesh control field. | |
6800 | * | |
6801 | * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers. | |
6802 | * @mesh_hdr: the type of mesh header to test | |
6803 | * 0: non-mesh A-MSDU length field | |
6804 | * 1: big-endian mesh A-MSDU length field | |
6805 | * 2: little-endian mesh A-MSDU length field | |
6806 | * Returns: true if subframe header lengths are valid for the @mesh_hdr mode | |
6807 | */ | |
6808 | bool ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 mesh_hdr); | |
6809 | ||
6810 | /** | |
6811 | * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame | |
6812 | * | |
6813 | * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames. | |
6814 | * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully | |
6815 | * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function. | |
6816 | * | |
6817 | * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers. | |
6818 | * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and | |
6819 | * initialized by the caller. | |
6820 | * @addr: The device MAC address. | |
6821 | * @iftype: The device interface type. | |
6822 | * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list. | |
6823 | * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL | |
6824 | * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL | |
6825 | * @mesh_control: see mesh_hdr in ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu | |
6826 | */ | |
6827 | void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list, | |
6828 | const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, | |
6829 | const unsigned int extra_headroom, | |
6830 | const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa, | |
6831 | u8 mesh_control); | |
6832 | ||
6833 | /** | |
6834 | * ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto - get RFC1042 or bridge tunnel encap protocol | |
6835 | * | |
6836 | * Check for RFC1042 or bridge tunnel header and fetch the encapsulated | |
6837 | * protocol. | |
6838 | * | |
6839 | * @hdr: pointer to the MSDU payload | |
6840 | * @proto: destination pointer to store the protocol | |
6841 | * Return: true if encapsulation was found | |
6842 | */ | |
6843 | bool ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto(const void *hdr, __be16 *proto); | |
6844 | ||
6845 | /** | |
6846 | * ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr - strip mesh header from converted 802.3 frames | |
6847 | * | |
6848 | * Strip the mesh header, which was left in by ieee80211_data_to_8023 as part | |
6849 | * of the MSDU data. Also move any source/destination addresses from the mesh | |
6850 | * header to the ethernet header (if present). | |
6851 | * | |
6852 | * @skb: The 802.3 frame with embedded mesh header | |
6853 | * | |
6854 | * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. | |
6855 | */ | |
6856 | int ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr(struct sk_buff *skb); | |
6857 | ||
6858 | /** | |
6859 | * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame | |
6860 | * @skb: the data frame | |
6861 | * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use | |
6862 | * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag. | |
6863 | */ | |
6864 | unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb, | |
6865 | struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map); | |
6866 | ||
6867 | /** | |
6868 | * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data | |
6869 | * | |
6870 | * @eid: element ID | |
6871 | * @ies: data consisting of IEs | |
6872 | * @len: length of data | |
6873 | * @match: byte array to match | |
6874 | * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array | |
6875 | * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match. | |
6876 | * Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers | |
6877 | * the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take | |
6878 | * the data portion instead. | |
6879 | * | |
6880 | * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if | |
6881 | * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given | |
6882 | * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the | |
6883 | * requested element struct. | |
6884 | * | |
6885 | * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than | |
6886 | * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the | |
6887 | * byte array to match. | |
6888 | */ | |
6889 | const struct element * | |
6890 | cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, | |
6891 | const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len, | |
6892 | unsigned int match_offset); | |
6893 | ||
6894 | /** | |
6895 | * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data | |
6896 | * | |
6897 | * @eid: element ID | |
6898 | * @ies: data consisting of IEs | |
6899 | * @len: length of data | |
6900 | * @match: byte array to match | |
6901 | * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array | |
6902 | * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match. | |
6903 | * If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero. | |
6904 | * Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first | |
6905 | * byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and | |
6906 | * the second byte is the IE length. | |
6907 | * | |
6908 | * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if | |
6909 | * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given | |
6910 | * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first | |
6911 | * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the | |
6912 | * element ID. | |
6913 | * | |
6914 | * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than | |
6915 | * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the | |
6916 | * byte array to match. | |
6917 | */ | |
6918 | static inline const u8 * | |
6919 | cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, | |
6920 | const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len, | |
6921 | unsigned int match_offset) | |
6922 | { | |
6923 | /* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is | |
6924 | * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well. | |
6925 | */ | |
6926 | if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) || | |
6927 | (!match_len && match_offset))) | |
6928 | return NULL; | |
6929 | ||
6930 | return (const void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, | |
6931 | match, match_len, | |
6932 | match_offset ? | |
6933 | match_offset - 2 : 0); | |
6934 | } | |
6935 | ||
6936 | /** | |
6937 | * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data | |
6938 | * | |
6939 | * @eid: element ID | |
6940 | * @ies: data consisting of IEs | |
6941 | * @len: length of data | |
6942 | * | |
6943 | * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if | |
6944 | * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given | |
6945 | * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the | |
6946 | * requested element struct. | |
6947 | * | |
6948 | * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than | |
6949 | * having to fit into the given data. | |
6950 | */ | |
6951 | static inline const struct element * | |
6952 | cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len) | |
6953 | { | |
6954 | return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0); | |
6955 | } | |
6956 | ||
6957 | /** | |
6958 | * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data | |
6959 | * | |
6960 | * @eid: element ID | |
6961 | * @ies: data consisting of IEs | |
6962 | * @len: length of data | |
6963 | * | |
6964 | * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if | |
6965 | * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given | |
6966 | * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested | |
6967 | * element, that is the byte containing the element ID. | |
6968 | * | |
6969 | * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than | |
6970 | * having to fit into the given data. | |
6971 | */ | |
6972 | static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len) | |
6973 | { | |
6974 | return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0); | |
6975 | } | |
6976 | ||
6977 | /** | |
6978 | * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data | |
6979 | * | |
6980 | * @ext_eid: element ID Extension | |
6981 | * @ies: data consisting of IEs | |
6982 | * @len: length of data | |
6983 | * | |
6984 | * Return: %NULL if the extended element could not be found or if | |
6985 | * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given | |
6986 | * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the | |
6987 | * requested element struct. | |
6988 | * | |
6989 | * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than | |
6990 | * having to fit into the given data. | |
6991 | */ | |
6992 | static inline const struct element * | |
6993 | cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len) | |
6994 | { | |
6995 | return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len, | |
6996 | &ext_eid, 1, 0); | |
6997 | } | |
6998 | ||
6999 | /** | |
7000 | * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data | |
7001 | * | |
7002 | * @ext_eid: element ID Extension | |
7003 | * @ies: data consisting of IEs | |
7004 | * @len: length of data | |
7005 | * | |
7006 | * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if | |
7007 | * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given | |
7008 | * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested | |
7009 | * element, that is the byte containing the element ID. | |
7010 | * | |
7011 | * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than | |
7012 | * having to fit into the given data. | |
7013 | */ | |
7014 | static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len) | |
7015 | { | |
7016 | return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len, | |
7017 | &ext_eid, 1, 2); | |
7018 | } | |
7019 | ||
7020 | /** | |
7021 | * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data | |
7022 | * | |
7023 | * @oui: vendor OUI | |
7024 | * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any | |
7025 | * @ies: data consisting of IEs | |
7026 | * @len: length of data | |
7027 | * | |
7028 | * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the | |
7029 | * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise | |
7030 | * return the element structure for the requested element. | |
7031 | * | |
7032 | * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into | |
7033 | * the given data. | |
7034 | */ | |
7035 | const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type, | |
7036 | const u8 *ies, | |
7037 | unsigned int len); | |
7038 | ||
7039 | /** | |
7040 | * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data | |
7041 | * | |
7042 | * @oui: vendor OUI | |
7043 | * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any | |
7044 | * @ies: data consisting of IEs | |
7045 | * @len: length of data | |
7046 | * | |
7047 | * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the | |
7048 | * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to | |
7049 | * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the | |
7050 | * element ID. | |
7051 | * | |
7052 | * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into | |
7053 | * the given data. | |
7054 | */ | |
7055 | static inline const u8 * | |
7056 | cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type, | |
7057 | const u8 *ies, unsigned int len) | |
7058 | { | |
7059 | return (const void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len); | |
7060 | } | |
7061 | ||
7062 | /** | |
7063 | * enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret - reduced neighbor report iteration state | |
7064 | * @RNR_ITER_CONTINUE: continue iterating with the next entry | |
7065 | * @RNR_ITER_BREAK: break iteration and return success | |
7066 | * @RNR_ITER_ERROR: break iteration and return error | |
7067 | */ | |
7068 | enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret { | |
7069 | RNR_ITER_CONTINUE, | |
7070 | RNR_ITER_BREAK, | |
7071 | RNR_ITER_ERROR, | |
7072 | }; | |
7073 | ||
7074 | /** | |
7075 | * cfg80211_iter_rnr - iterate reduced neighbor report entries | |
7076 | * @elems: the frame elements to iterate RNR elements and then | |
7077 | * their entries in | |
7078 | * @elems_len: length of the elements | |
7079 | * @iter: iteration function, see also &enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret | |
7080 | * for the return value | |
7081 | * @iter_data: additional data passed to the iteration function | |
7082 | * Return: %true on success (after successfully iterating all entries | |
7083 | * or if the iteration function returned %RNR_ITER_BREAK), | |
7084 | * %false on error (iteration function returned %RNR_ITER_ERROR | |
7085 | * or elements were malformed.) | |
7086 | */ | |
7087 | bool cfg80211_iter_rnr(const u8 *elems, size_t elems_len, | |
7088 | enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret | |
7089 | (*iter)(void *data, u8 type, | |
7090 | const struct ieee80211_neighbor_ap_info *info, | |
7091 | const u8 *tbtt_info, u8 tbtt_info_len), | |
7092 | void *iter_data); | |
7093 | ||
7094 | /** | |
7095 | * cfg80211_defragment_element - Defrag the given element data into a buffer | |
7096 | * | |
7097 | * @elem: the element to defragment | |
7098 | * @ies: elements where @elem is contained | |
7099 | * @ieslen: length of @ies | |
7100 | * @data: buffer to store element data, or %NULL to just determine size | |
7101 | * @data_len: length of @data, or 0 | |
7102 | * @frag_id: the element ID of fragments | |
7103 | * | |
7104 | * Return: length of @data, or -EINVAL on error | |
7105 | * | |
7106 | * Copy out all data from an element that may be fragmented into @data, while | |
7107 | * skipping all headers. | |
7108 | * | |
7109 | * The function uses memmove() internally. It is acceptable to defragment an | |
7110 | * element in-place. | |
7111 | */ | |
7112 | ssize_t cfg80211_defragment_element(const struct element *elem, const u8 *ies, | |
7113 | size_t ieslen, u8 *data, size_t data_len, | |
7114 | u8 frag_id); | |
7115 | ||
7116 | /** | |
7117 | * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame | |
7118 | * | |
7119 | * @dev: network device | |
7120 | * @addr: STA MAC address | |
7121 | * | |
7122 | * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge | |
7123 | * devices upon STA association. | |
7124 | */ | |
7125 | void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr); | |
7126 | ||
7127 | /** | |
7128 | * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure | |
7129 | * | |
7130 | * TODO | |
7131 | */ | |
7132 | ||
7133 | /** | |
7134 | * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain | |
7135 | * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting | |
7136 | * conflicts) | |
7137 | * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain | |
7138 | * should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you | |
7139 | * set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted | |
7140 | * alpha2. | |
7141 | * | |
7142 | * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core | |
7143 | * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by | |
7144 | * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory | |
7145 | * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain. | |
7146 | * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried | |
7147 | * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country. | |
7148 | * | |
7149 | * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call. | |
7150 | * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(), | |
7151 | * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw(). | |
7152 | * | |
7153 | * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get | |
7154 | * an -ENOMEM. | |
7155 | * | |
7156 | * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM. | |
7157 | */ | |
7158 | int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2); | |
7159 | ||
7160 | /** | |
7161 | * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers | |
7162 | * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on | |
7163 | * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy | |
7164 | * | |
7165 | * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they | |
7166 | * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more | |
7167 | * information. | |
7168 | * | |
7169 | * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM | |
7170 | */ | |
7171 | int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
7172 | struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd); | |
7173 | ||
7174 | /** | |
7175 | * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync - set regdom for self-managed drivers | |
7176 | * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on | |
7177 | * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy | |
7178 | * | |
7179 | * This functions requires the RTNL and the wiphy mutex to be held and | |
7180 | * applies the new regdomain synchronously to this wiphy. For more details | |
7181 | * see regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(). | |
7182 | * | |
7183 | * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM | |
7184 | */ | |
7185 | int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
7186 | struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd); | |
7187 | ||
7188 | /** | |
7189 | * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain | |
7190 | * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on | |
7191 | * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy | |
7192 | * | |
7193 | * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply | |
7194 | * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory | |
7195 | * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The | |
7196 | * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous | |
7197 | * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a | |
7198 | * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled. | |
7199 | * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag | |
7200 | * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy | |
7201 | * that called this helper. | |
7202 | */ | |
7203 | void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
7204 | const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd); | |
7205 | ||
7206 | /** | |
7207 | * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency | |
7208 | * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for | |
7209 | * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for | |
7210 | * | |
7211 | * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on | |
7212 | * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain | |
7213 | * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received | |
7214 | * and processed already. | |
7215 | * | |
7216 | * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule | |
7217 | * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to | |
7218 | * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return | |
7219 | * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even | |
7220 | * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band. | |
7221 | * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is | |
7222 | * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific. | |
7223 | */ | |
7224 | const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
7225 | u32 center_freq); | |
7226 | ||
7227 | /** | |
7228 | * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name | |
7229 | * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator | |
7230 | * | |
7231 | * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a | |
7232 | * proper string representation. | |
7233 | * | |
7234 | * Return: pointer to string representation of the initiator | |
7235 | */ | |
7236 | const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator); | |
7237 | ||
7238 | /** | |
7239 | * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom | |
7240 | * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked. | |
7241 | * | |
7242 | * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI). | |
7243 | * | |
7244 | * Return: %true if allowed, %false otherwise | |
7245 | */ | |
7246 | bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy); | |
7247 | ||
7248 | /** | |
7249 | * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions | |
7250 | * | |
7251 | */ | |
7252 | ||
7253 | /** | |
7254 | * reg_query_regdb_wmm - Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule | |
7255 | * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively | |
7256 | * | |
7257 | * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried. | |
7258 | * @freq: the frequency (in MHz) to be queried. | |
7259 | * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db. | |
7260 | * | |
7261 | * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to query | |
7262 | * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given | |
7263 | * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations. | |
7264 | * | |
7265 | * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get | |
7266 | * an -ENODATA. | |
7267 | * | |
7268 | * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA. | |
7269 | */ | |
7270 | int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq, | |
7271 | struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule); | |
7272 | ||
7273 | /* | |
7274 | * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification | |
7275 | * functions and BSS handling helpers | |
7276 | */ | |
7277 | ||
7278 | /** | |
7279 | * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished | |
7280 | * | |
7281 | * @request: the corresponding scan request | |
7282 | * @info: information about the completed scan | |
7283 | */ | |
7284 | void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request, | |
7285 | struct cfg80211_scan_info *info); | |
7286 | ||
7287 | /** | |
7288 | * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available | |
7289 | * | |
7290 | * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results | |
7291 | * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request | |
7292 | */ | |
7293 | void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); | |
7294 | ||
7295 | /** | |
7296 | * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped | |
7297 | * | |
7298 | * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped | |
7299 | * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request | |
7300 | * | |
7301 | * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the | |
7302 | * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver | |
7303 | * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done. | |
7304 | */ | |
7305 | void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); | |
7306 | ||
7307 | /** | |
7308 | * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped | |
7309 | * | |
7310 | * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped | |
7311 | * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request | |
7312 | * | |
7313 | * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the | |
7314 | * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver | |
7315 | * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done. | |
7316 | * This function should be called with the wiphy mutex held. | |
7317 | */ | |
7318 | void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); | |
7319 | ||
7320 | /** | |
7321 | * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame | |
7322 | * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS | |
7323 | * @data: the BSS metadata | |
7324 | * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon) | |
7325 | * @len: length of the management frame | |
7326 | * @gfp: context flags | |
7327 | * | |
7328 | * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and | |
7329 | * the BSS should be updated/added. | |
7330 | * | |
7331 | * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()! | |
7332 | * Or %NULL on error. | |
7333 | */ | |
7334 | struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check | |
7335 | cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
7336 | struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data, | |
7337 | struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, | |
7338 | gfp_t gfp); | |
7339 | ||
7340 | static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check | |
7341 | cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
7342 | struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, | |
7343 | struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, | |
7344 | s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) | |
7345 | { | |
7346 | struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { | |
7347 | .chan = rx_channel, | |
7348 | .signal = signal, | |
7349 | }; | |
7350 | ||
7351 | return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp); | |
7352 | } | |
7353 | ||
7354 | /** | |
7355 | * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID | |
7356 | * @bssid: transmitter BSSID | |
7357 | * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element | |
7358 | * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element | |
7359 | * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID | |
7360 | */ | |
7361 | static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid, | |
7362 | u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid) | |
7363 | { | |
7364 | u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid); | |
7365 | u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0); | |
7366 | u64 new_bssid_u64; | |
7367 | ||
7368 | new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask; | |
7369 | ||
7370 | new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask; | |
7371 | ||
7372 | u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid); | |
7373 | } | |
7374 | ||
7375 | /** | |
7376 | * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited | |
7377 | * @element: element to check | |
7378 | * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element | |
7379 | * | |
7380 | * Return: %true if should be inherited, %false otherwise | |
7381 | */ | |
7382 | bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element, | |
7383 | const struct element *non_inherit_element); | |
7384 | ||
7385 | /** | |
7386 | * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs | |
7387 | * @ie: ies | |
7388 | * @ielen: length of IEs | |
7389 | * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element | |
7390 | * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile) | |
7391 | * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile | |
7392 | * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length | |
7393 | * | |
7394 | * Return: the number of bytes merged | |
7395 | */ | |
7396 | size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, | |
7397 | const struct element *mbssid_elem, | |
7398 | const struct element *sub_elem, | |
7399 | u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len); | |
7400 | ||
7401 | /** | |
7402 | * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from | |
7403 | * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is | |
7404 | * from a beacon or probe response | |
7405 | * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon | |
7406 | * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response | |
7407 | * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_S1G_BEACON: data comes from an S1G beacon | |
7408 | */ | |
7409 | enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type { | |
7410 | CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN, | |
7411 | CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON, | |
7412 | CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP, | |
7413 | CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_S1G_BEACON, | |
7414 | }; | |
7415 | ||
7416 | /** | |
7417 | * cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number - returns the channel number from ies | |
7418 | * @ie: IEs | |
7419 | * @ielen: length of IEs | |
7420 | * @band: enum nl80211_band of the channel | |
7421 | * | |
7422 | * Return: the channel number, or -1 if none could be determined. | |
7423 | */ | |
7424 | int cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, | |
7425 | enum nl80211_band band); | |
7426 | ||
7427 | /** | |
7428 | * cfg80211_ssid_eq - compare two SSIDs | |
7429 | * @a: first SSID | |
7430 | * @b: second SSID | |
7431 | * | |
7432 | * Return: %true if SSIDs are equal, %false otherwise. | |
7433 | */ | |
7434 | static inline bool | |
7435 | cfg80211_ssid_eq(struct cfg80211_ssid *a, struct cfg80211_ssid *b) | |
7436 | { | |
7437 | if (WARN_ON(!a || !b)) | |
7438 | return false; | |
7439 | if (a->ssid_len != b->ssid_len) | |
7440 | return false; | |
7441 | return memcmp(a->ssid, b->ssid, a->ssid_len) ? false : true; | |
7442 | } | |
7443 | ||
7444 | /** | |
7445 | * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS | |
7446 | * | |
7447 | * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS | |
7448 | * @data: the BSS metadata | |
7449 | * @ftype: frame type (if known) | |
7450 | * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS | |
7451 | * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0) | |
7452 | * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer | |
7453 | * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer | |
7454 | * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer | |
7455 | * @ielen: length of the additional IEs | |
7456 | * @gfp: context flags | |
7457 | * | |
7458 | * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and | |
7459 | * the BSS should be updated/added. | |
7460 | * | |
7461 | * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()! | |
7462 | * Or %NULL on error. | |
7463 | */ | |
7464 | struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check | |
7465 | cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
7466 | struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data, | |
7467 | enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, | |
7468 | const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, | |
7469 | u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, | |
7470 | gfp_t gfp); | |
7471 | ||
7472 | static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check | |
7473 | cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
7474 | struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, | |
7475 | enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, | |
7476 | const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, | |
7477 | u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, | |
7478 | s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) | |
7479 | { | |
7480 | struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { | |
7481 | .chan = rx_channel, | |
7482 | .signal = signal, | |
7483 | }; | |
7484 | ||
7485 | return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf, | |
7486 | capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen, | |
7487 | gfp); | |
7488 | } | |
7489 | ||
7490 | /** | |
7491 | * __cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference | |
7492 | * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to | |
7493 | * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL) | |
7494 | * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL) | |
7495 | * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL) | |
7496 | * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0) | |
7497 | * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type | |
7498 | * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy | |
7499 | * @use_for: indicates which use is intended | |
7500 | * | |
7501 | * Return: Reference-counted BSS on success. %NULL on error. | |
7502 | */ | |
7503 | struct cfg80211_bss *__cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
7504 | struct ieee80211_channel *channel, | |
7505 | const u8 *bssid, | |
7506 | const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len, | |
7507 | enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type, | |
7508 | enum ieee80211_privacy privacy, | |
7509 | u32 use_for); | |
7510 | ||
7511 | /** | |
7512 | * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference | |
7513 | * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to | |
7514 | * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL) | |
7515 | * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL) | |
7516 | * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL) | |
7517 | * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0) | |
7518 | * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type | |
7519 | * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy | |
7520 | * | |
7521 | * This version implies regular usage, %NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL. | |
7522 | * | |
7523 | * Return: Reference-counted BSS on success. %NULL on error. | |
7524 | */ | |
7525 | static inline struct cfg80211_bss * | |
7526 | cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct ieee80211_channel *channel, | |
7527 | const u8 *bssid, const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len, | |
7528 | enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type, | |
7529 | enum ieee80211_privacy privacy) | |
7530 | { | |
7531 | return __cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, bssid, ssid, ssid_len, | |
7532 | bss_type, privacy, | |
7533 | NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL); | |
7534 | } | |
7535 | ||
7536 | static inline struct cfg80211_bss * | |
7537 | cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
7538 | struct ieee80211_channel *channel, | |
7539 | const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len) | |
7540 | { | |
7541 | return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len, | |
7542 | IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS, | |
7543 | IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY); | |
7544 | } | |
7545 | ||
7546 | /** | |
7547 | * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct | |
7548 | * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to | |
7549 | * @bss: the BSS struct to reference | |
7550 | * | |
7551 | * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct. | |
7552 | */ | |
7553 | void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); | |
7554 | ||
7555 | /** | |
7556 | * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct | |
7557 | * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to | |
7558 | * @bss: the BSS struct | |
7559 | * | |
7560 | * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct. | |
7561 | */ | |
7562 | void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); | |
7563 | ||
7564 | /** | |
7565 | * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures | |
7566 | * @wiphy: the wiphy | |
7567 | * @bss: the bss to remove | |
7568 | * | |
7569 | * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures | |
7570 | * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this | |
7571 | * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time | |
7572 | * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all. | |
7573 | */ | |
7574 | void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); | |
7575 | ||
7576 | /** | |
7577 | * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries | |
7578 | * | |
7579 | * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy | |
7580 | * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not | |
7581 | * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB. | |
7582 | * | |
7583 | * @wiphy: the wiphy | |
7584 | * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel | |
7585 | * of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel. | |
7586 | * @iter: the iterator function to call | |
7587 | * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function | |
7588 | */ | |
7589 | void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
7590 | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | |
7591 | void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
7592 | struct cfg80211_bss *bss, | |
7593 | void *data), | |
7594 | void *iter_data); | |
7595 | ||
7596 | /** | |
7597 | * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame | |
7598 | * @dev: network device | |
7599 | * @buf: authentication frame (header + body) | |
7600 | * @len: length of the frame data | |
7601 | * | |
7602 | * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or | |
7603 | * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode. | |
7604 | * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must | |
7605 | * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). | |
7606 | * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must | |
7607 | * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). | |
7608 | * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed | |
7609 | * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used | |
7610 | * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function | |
7611 | * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead. | |
7612 | * | |
7613 | * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. | |
7614 | */ | |
7615 | void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len); | |
7616 | ||
7617 | /** | |
7618 | * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication | |
7619 | * @dev: network device | |
7620 | * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out | |
7621 | * | |
7622 | * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's | |
7623 | * mutex. | |
7624 | */ | |
7625 | void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr); | |
7626 | ||
7627 | /** | |
7628 | * struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data - association response data | |
7629 | * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body) | |
7630 | * @len: length of the frame data | |
7631 | * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format | |
7632 | * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field | |
7633 | * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame | |
7634 | * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data | |
7635 | * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address (in case of MLO) | |
7636 | * @links: per-link information indexed by link ID, use links[0] for | |
7637 | * non-MLO connections | |
7638 | * @links.bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the | |
7639 | * pointer moves to cfg80211 in the call to cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp() | |
7640 | * @links.status: Set this (along with a BSS pointer) for links that | |
7641 | * were rejected by the AP. | |
7642 | */ | |
7643 | struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data { | |
7644 | const u8 *buf; | |
7645 | size_t len; | |
7646 | const u8 *req_ies; | |
7647 | size_t req_ies_len; | |
7648 | int uapsd_queues; | |
7649 | const u8 *ap_mld_addr; | |
7650 | struct { | |
7651 | u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); | |
7652 | struct cfg80211_bss *bss; | |
7653 | u16 status; | |
7654 | } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; | |
7655 | }; | |
7656 | ||
7657 | /** | |
7658 | * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response | |
7659 | * @dev: network device | |
7660 | * @data: association response data, &struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data | |
7661 | * | |
7662 | * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must | |
7663 | * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). | |
7664 | * | |
7665 | * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. | |
7666 | */ | |
7667 | void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev, | |
7668 | const struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data *data); | |
7669 | ||
7670 | /** | |
7671 | * struct cfg80211_assoc_failure - association failure data | |
7672 | * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address, or %NULL | |
7673 | * @bss: list of BSSes, must use entry 0 for non-MLO connections | |
7674 | * (@ap_mld_addr is %NULL) | |
7675 | * @timeout: indicates the association failed due to timeout, otherwise | |
7676 | * the association was abandoned for a reason reported through some | |
7677 | * other API (e.g. deauth RX) | |
7678 | */ | |
7679 | struct cfg80211_assoc_failure { | |
7680 | const u8 *ap_mld_addr; | |
7681 | struct cfg80211_bss *bss[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; | |
7682 | bool timeout; | |
7683 | }; | |
7684 | ||
7685 | /** | |
7686 | * cfg80211_assoc_failure - notification of association failure | |
7687 | * @dev: network device | |
7688 | * @data: data describing the association failure | |
7689 | * | |
7690 | * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. | |
7691 | */ | |
7692 | void cfg80211_assoc_failure(struct net_device *dev, | |
7693 | struct cfg80211_assoc_failure *data); | |
7694 | ||
7695 | /** | |
7696 | * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame | |
7697 | * @dev: network device | |
7698 | * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body) | |
7699 | * @len: length of the frame data | |
7700 | * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired (include the nl80211 attribute) | |
7701 | * | |
7702 | * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in | |
7703 | * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and | |
7704 | * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the | |
7705 | * corresponding wdev's mutex. | |
7706 | */ | |
7707 | void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len, | |
7708 | bool reconnect); | |
7709 | ||
7710 | /** | |
7711 | * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame | |
7712 | * @dev: network device | |
7713 | * @buf: received management frame (header + body) | |
7714 | * @len: length of the frame data | |
7715 | * | |
7716 | * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc | |
7717 | * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the | |
7718 | * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon | |
7719 | * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while | |
7720 | * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode). | |
7721 | * | |
7722 | * This function may sleep. | |
7723 | */ | |
7724 | void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, | |
7725 | const u8 *buf, size_t len); | |
7726 | ||
7727 | /** | |
7728 | * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP) | |
7729 | * @dev: network device | |
7730 | * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame | |
7731 | * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used | |
7732 | * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing. | |
7733 | * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets) | |
7734 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
7735 | * | |
7736 | * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a | |
7737 | * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication() | |
7738 | * primitive. | |
7739 | */ | |
7740 | void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr, | |
7741 | enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id, | |
7742 | const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp); | |
7743 | ||
7744 | /** | |
7745 | * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS | |
7746 | * | |
7747 | * @dev: network device | |
7748 | * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined | |
7749 | * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined | |
7750 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
7751 | * | |
7752 | * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or | |
7753 | * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called, | |
7754 | * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of | |
7755 | * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called | |
7756 | * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is | |
7757 | * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest. | |
7758 | */ | |
7759 | void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, | |
7760 | struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp); | |
7761 | ||
7762 | /** | |
7763 | * cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer | |
7764 | * candidate | |
7765 | * | |
7766 | * @dev: network device | |
7767 | * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate | |
7768 | * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate | |
7769 | * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer | |
7770 | * @sig_dbm: signal level in dBm | |
7771 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
7772 | * | |
7773 | * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been | |
7774 | * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response. | |
7775 | * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace. | |
7776 | */ | |
7777 | void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev, | |
7778 | const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len, | |
7779 | int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp); | |
7780 | ||
7781 | /** | |
7782 | * DOC: RFkill integration | |
7783 | * | |
7784 | * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers, | |
7785 | * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each | |
7786 | * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated | |
7787 | * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off. Drivers are | |
7788 | * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down. | |
7789 | * | |
7790 | * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they | |
7791 | * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211. | |
7792 | * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here. | |
7793 | */ | |
7794 | ||
7795 | /** | |
7796 | * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason - notify cfg80211 about hw block state | |
7797 | * @wiphy: the wiphy | |
7798 | * @blocked: block status | |
7799 | * @reason: one of reasons in &enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons | |
7800 | */ | |
7801 | void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked, | |
7802 | enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons reason); | |
7803 | ||
7804 | static inline void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked) | |
7805 | { | |
7806 | wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(wiphy, blocked, | |
7807 | RFKILL_HARD_BLOCK_SIGNAL); | |
7808 | } | |
7809 | ||
7810 | /** | |
7811 | * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill | |
7812 | * @wiphy: the wiphy | |
7813 | */ | |
7814 | void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy); | |
7815 | ||
7816 | /** | |
7817 | * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill | |
7818 | * @wiphy: the wiphy | |
7819 | */ | |
7820 | static inline void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy) | |
7821 | { | |
7822 | rfkill_pause_polling(wiphy->rfkill); | |
7823 | } | |
7824 | ||
7825 | /** | |
7826 | * DOC: Vendor commands | |
7827 | * | |
7828 | * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that | |
7829 | * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the | |
7830 | * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with | |
7831 | * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as | |
7832 | * the configuration mechanism. | |
7833 | * | |
7834 | * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array | |
7835 | * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one. Each command has an | |
7836 | * OUI and sub command ID to identify it. | |
7837 | * | |
7838 | * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol | |
7839 | * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular, | |
7840 | * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any | |
7841 | * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection | |
7842 | * managers etc. need. | |
7843 | */ | |
7844 | ||
7845 | struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
7846 | enum nl80211_commands cmd, | |
7847 | enum nl80211_attrs attr, | |
7848 | int approxlen); | |
7849 | ||
7850 | struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
7851 | struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
7852 | enum nl80211_commands cmd, | |
7853 | enum nl80211_attrs attr, | |
7854 | unsigned int portid, | |
7855 | int vendor_event_idx, | |
7856 | int approxlen, gfp_t gfp); | |
7857 | ||
7858 | void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp); | |
7859 | ||
7860 | /** | |
7861 | * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply | |
7862 | * @wiphy: the wiphy | |
7863 | * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will | |
7864 | * be put into the skb | |
7865 | * | |
7866 | * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to | |
7867 | * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling | |
7868 | * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid. | |
7869 | * | |
7870 | * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in | |
7871 | * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(), | |
7872 | * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the | |
7873 | * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done | |
7874 | * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool | |
7875 | * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute. | |
7876 | * You must not modify the skb in any other way. | |
7877 | * | |
7878 | * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return | |
7879 | * its error code as the result of the doit() operation. | |
7880 | * | |
7881 | * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. | |
7882 | */ | |
7883 | static inline struct sk_buff * | |
7884 | cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen) | |
7885 | { | |
7886 | return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, | |
7887 | NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen); | |
7888 | } | |
7889 | ||
7890 | /** | |
7891 | * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb | |
7892 | * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with | |
7893 | * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb() | |
7894 | * | |
7895 | * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing | |
7896 | * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should | |
7897 | * return the error code. Note that this function consumes the | |
7898 | * skb regardless of the return value. | |
7899 | * | |
7900 | * Return: An error code or 0 on success. | |
7901 | */ | |
7902 | int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb); | |
7903 | ||
7904 | /** | |
7905 | * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender - get the current sender netlink ID | |
7906 | * @wiphy: the wiphy | |
7907 | * | |
7908 | * Return: the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler. | |
7909 | * | |
7910 | * Context: May only be called from a vendor command handler | |
7911 | */ | |
7912 | unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy); | |
7913 | ||
7914 | /** | |
7915 | * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb | |
7916 | * @wiphy: the wiphy | |
7917 | * @wdev: the wireless device | |
7918 | * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events | |
7919 | * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will | |
7920 | * be put into the skb | |
7921 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
7922 | * | |
7923 | * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the | |
7924 | * vendor-specific multicast group. | |
7925 | * | |
7926 | * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified | |
7927 | * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data | |
7928 | * attribute. | |
7929 | * | |
7930 | * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the | |
7931 | * skb to send the event. | |
7932 | * | |
7933 | * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. | |
7934 | */ | |
7935 | static inline struct sk_buff * | |
7936 | cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
7937 | int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp) | |
7938 | { | |
7939 | return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, | |
7940 | NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, | |
7941 | 0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp); | |
7942 | } | |
7943 | ||
7944 | /** | |
7945 | * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb | |
7946 | * @wiphy: the wiphy | |
7947 | * @wdev: the wireless device | |
7948 | * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events | |
7949 | * @portid: port ID of the receiver | |
7950 | * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will | |
7951 | * be put into the skb | |
7952 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
7953 | * | |
7954 | * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to | |
7955 | * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been | |
7956 | * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take | |
7957 | * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes. | |
7958 | * | |
7959 | * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified | |
7960 | * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data | |
7961 | * attribute. | |
7962 | * | |
7963 | * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the | |
7964 | * skb to send the event. | |
7965 | * | |
7966 | * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. | |
7967 | */ | |
7968 | static inline struct sk_buff * | |
7969 | cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
7970 | struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
7971 | unsigned int portid, int approxlen, | |
7972 | int event_idx, gfp_t gfp) | |
7973 | { | |
7974 | return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, | |
7975 | NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, | |
7976 | portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp); | |
7977 | } | |
7978 | ||
7979 | /** | |
7980 | * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event | |
7981 | * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc() | |
7982 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
7983 | * | |
7984 | * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated | |
7985 | * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it. | |
7986 | */ | |
7987 | static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp) | |
7988 | { | |
7989 | __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp); | |
7990 | } | |
7991 | ||
7992 | #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE | |
7993 | /** | |
7994 | * DOC: Test mode | |
7995 | * | |
7996 | * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to | |
7997 | * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance, | |
7998 | * factory programming. | |
7999 | * | |
8000 | * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it. For more | |
8001 | * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it. | |
8002 | */ | |
8003 | ||
8004 | /** | |
8005 | * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply | |
8006 | * @wiphy: the wiphy | |
8007 | * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will | |
8008 | * be put into the skb | |
8009 | * | |
8010 | * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to | |
8011 | * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling | |
8012 | * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid. | |
8013 | * | |
8014 | * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in | |
8015 | * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(), | |
8016 | * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the | |
8017 | * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done | |
8018 | * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool | |
8019 | * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You | |
8020 | * must not modify the skb in any other way. | |
8021 | * | |
8022 | * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return | |
8023 | * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation. | |
8024 | * | |
8025 | * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. | |
8026 | */ | |
8027 | static inline struct sk_buff * | |
8028 | cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen) | |
8029 | { | |
8030 | return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE, | |
8031 | NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen); | |
8032 | } | |
8033 | ||
8034 | /** | |
8035 | * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb | |
8036 | * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with | |
8037 | * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() | |
8038 | * | |
8039 | * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing | |
8040 | * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return | |
8041 | * the error code. Note that this function consumes the skb | |
8042 | * regardless of the return value. | |
8043 | * | |
8044 | * Return: An error code or 0 on success. | |
8045 | */ | |
8046 | static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb) | |
8047 | { | |
8048 | return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb); | |
8049 | } | |
8050 | ||
8051 | /** | |
8052 | * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event | |
8053 | * @wiphy: the wiphy | |
8054 | * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will | |
8055 | * be put into the skb | |
8056 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
8057 | * | |
8058 | * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the | |
8059 | * testmode multicast group. | |
8060 | * | |
8061 | * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with | |
8062 | * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As | |
8063 | * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the | |
8064 | * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb | |
8065 | * in any other way. | |
8066 | * | |
8067 | * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the | |
8068 | * skb to send the event. | |
8069 | * | |
8070 | * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. | |
8071 | */ | |
8072 | static inline struct sk_buff * | |
8073 | cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp) | |
8074 | { | |
8075 | return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE, | |
8076 | NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1, | |
8077 | approxlen, gfp); | |
8078 | } | |
8079 | ||
8080 | /** | |
8081 | * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event | |
8082 | * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with | |
8083 | * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb() | |
8084 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
8085 | * | |
8086 | * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated | |
8087 | * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always | |
8088 | * consumes it. | |
8089 | */ | |
8090 | static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp) | |
8091 | { | |
8092 | __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp); | |
8093 | } | |
8094 | ||
8095 | #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd) .testmode_cmd = (cmd), | |
8096 | #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd) .testmode_dump = (cmd), | |
8097 | #else | |
8098 | #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd) | |
8099 | #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd) | |
8100 | #endif | |
8101 | ||
8102 | /** | |
8103 | * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params | |
8104 | * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL) | |
8105 | * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets | |
8106 | * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in | |
8107 | * @erp_next_seq_num is valid. | |
8108 | * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in | |
8109 | * FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the | |
8110 | * status for a FILS connection. | |
8111 | * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL). | |
8112 | * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets | |
8113 | * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID | |
8114 | * used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL). | |
8115 | */ | |
8116 | struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params { | |
8117 | const u8 *kek; | |
8118 | size_t kek_len; | |
8119 | bool update_erp_next_seq_num; | |
8120 | u16 erp_next_seq_num; | |
8121 | const u8 *pmk; | |
8122 | size_t pmk_len; | |
8123 | const u8 *pmkid; | |
8124 | }; | |
8125 | ||
8126 | /** | |
8127 | * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params | |
8128 | * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use | |
8129 | * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you | |
8130 | * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a | |
8131 | * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame | |
8132 | * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to | |
8133 | * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code. | |
8134 | * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that | |
8135 | * case. | |
8136 | * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL) | |
8137 | * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length | |
8138 | * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL) | |
8139 | * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length | |
8140 | * @fils: FILS connection response parameters. | |
8141 | * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the | |
8142 | * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from | |
8143 | * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is | |
8144 | * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the | |
8145 | * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP. | |
8146 | * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0). | |
8147 | * @valid_links: For MLO connection, BIT mask of the valid link ids. Otherwise | |
8148 | * zero. | |
8149 | * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the AP. Otherwise %NULL. | |
8150 | * @links : For MLO connection, contains link info for the valid links indicated | |
8151 | * using @valid_links. For non-MLO connection, links[0] contains the | |
8152 | * connected AP info. | |
8153 | * @links.addr: For MLO connection, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise | |
8154 | * %NULL. | |
8155 | * @links.bssid: For MLO connection, MAC address of the AP link. For non-MLO | |
8156 | * connection, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL). | |
8157 | * @links.bss: For MLO connection, entry of bss to which STA link is connected. | |
8158 | * For non-MLO connection, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to which STA | |
8159 | * is connected. It can be obtained through cfg80211_get_bss() (may be | |
8160 | * %NULL). It is recommended to store the bss from the connect_request and | |
8161 | * hold a reference to it and return through this param to avoid a warning | |
8162 | * if the bss is expired during the connection, esp. for those drivers | |
8163 | * implementing connect op. Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs | |
8164 | * to be specified. | |
8165 | * @links.status: per-link status code, to report a status code that's not | |
8166 | * %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for a given link, it must also be in the | |
8167 | * @valid_links bitmap and may have a BSS pointer (which is then released) | |
8168 | */ | |
8169 | struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params { | |
8170 | int status; | |
8171 | const u8 *req_ie; | |
8172 | size_t req_ie_len; | |
8173 | const u8 *resp_ie; | |
8174 | size_t resp_ie_len; | |
8175 | struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils; | |
8176 | enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason; | |
8177 | ||
8178 | const u8 *ap_mld_addr; | |
8179 | u16 valid_links; | |
8180 | struct { | |
8181 | const u8 *addr; | |
8182 | const u8 *bssid; | |
8183 | struct cfg80211_bss *bss; | |
8184 | u16 status; | |
8185 | } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; | |
8186 | }; | |
8187 | ||
8188 | /** | |
8189 | * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result | |
8190 | * | |
8191 | * @dev: network device | |
8192 | * @params: connection response parameters | |
8193 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
8194 | * | |
8195 | * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection | |
8196 | * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to | |
8197 | * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response | |
8198 | * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), | |
8199 | * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(), | |
8200 | * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. | |
8201 | */ | |
8202 | void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev, | |
8203 | struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params, | |
8204 | gfp_t gfp); | |
8205 | ||
8206 | /** | |
8207 | * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result | |
8208 | * | |
8209 | * @dev: network device | |
8210 | * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP | |
8211 | * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through | |
8212 | * cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the | |
8213 | * bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return | |
8214 | * through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the | |
8215 | * connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op. | |
8216 | * Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified. | |
8217 | * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) | |
8218 | * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length | |
8219 | * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) | |
8220 | * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length | |
8221 | * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use | |
8222 | * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you | |
8223 | * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a | |
8224 | * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame | |
8225 | * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to | |
8226 | * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code. | |
8227 | * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that | |
8228 | * case. | |
8229 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
8230 | * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the | |
8231 | * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from | |
8232 | * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is | |
8233 | * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the | |
8234 | * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP. | |
8235 | * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0). | |
8236 | * | |
8237 | * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection | |
8238 | * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to | |
8239 | * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss | |
8240 | * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among | |
8241 | * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), | |
8242 | * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. | |
8243 | */ | |
8244 | static inline void | |
8245 | cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, | |
8246 | struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie, | |
8247 | size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie, | |
8248 | size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp, | |
8249 | enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason) | |
8250 | { | |
8251 | struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params; | |
8252 | ||
8253 | memset(¶ms, 0, sizeof(params)); | |
8254 | params.status = status; | |
8255 | params.links[0].bssid = bssid; | |
8256 | params.links[0].bss = bss; | |
8257 | params.req_ie = req_ie; | |
8258 | params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len; | |
8259 | params.resp_ie = resp_ie; | |
8260 | params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len; | |
8261 | params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason; | |
8262 | ||
8263 | cfg80211_connect_done(dev, ¶ms, gfp); | |
8264 | } | |
8265 | ||
8266 | /** | |
8267 | * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result | |
8268 | * | |
8269 | * @dev: network device | |
8270 | * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP | |
8271 | * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) | |
8272 | * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length | |
8273 | * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) | |
8274 | * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length | |
8275 | * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use | |
8276 | * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you | |
8277 | * the real status code for failures. | |
8278 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
8279 | * | |
8280 | * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection | |
8281 | * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to | |
8282 | * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only | |
8283 | * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), | |
8284 | * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. | |
8285 | */ | |
8286 | static inline void | |
8287 | cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, | |
8288 | const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, | |
8289 | const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len, | |
8290 | u16 status, gfp_t gfp) | |
8291 | { | |
8292 | cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie, | |
8293 | resp_ie_len, status, gfp, | |
8294 | NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED); | |
8295 | } | |
8296 | ||
8297 | /** | |
8298 | * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout | |
8299 | * | |
8300 | * @dev: network device | |
8301 | * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP | |
8302 | * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) | |
8303 | * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length | |
8304 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
8305 | * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. | |
8306 | * | |
8307 | * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed | |
8308 | * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was | |
8309 | * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send | |
8310 | * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while | |
8311 | * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among | |
8312 | * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), | |
8313 | * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. | |
8314 | */ | |
8315 | static inline void | |
8316 | cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, | |
8317 | const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp, | |
8318 | enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason) | |
8319 | { | |
8320 | cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1, | |
8321 | gfp, timeout_reason); | |
8322 | } | |
8323 | ||
8324 | /** | |
8325 | * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information | |
8326 | * | |
8327 | * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) | |
8328 | * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length | |
8329 | * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) | |
8330 | * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length | |
8331 | * @fils: FILS related roaming information. | |
8332 | * @valid_links: For MLO roaming, BIT mask of the new valid links is set. | |
8333 | * Otherwise zero. | |
8334 | * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO roaming, MLD address of the new AP. Otherwise %NULL. | |
8335 | * @links : For MLO roaming, contains new link info for the valid links set in | |
8336 | * @valid_links. For non-MLO roaming, links[0] contains the new AP info. | |
8337 | * @links.addr: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise %NULL. | |
8338 | * @links.bssid: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the new AP link. For non-MLO | |
8339 | * roaming, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the new AP. May be | |
8340 | * %NULL if %links.bss is set. | |
8341 | * @links.channel: the channel of the new AP. | |
8342 | * @links.bss: For MLO roaming, entry of new bss to which STA link got | |
8343 | * roamed. For non-MLO roaming, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to | |
8344 | * which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %links.bssid is set) | |
8345 | */ | |
8346 | struct cfg80211_roam_info { | |
8347 | const u8 *req_ie; | |
8348 | size_t req_ie_len; | |
8349 | const u8 *resp_ie; | |
8350 | size_t resp_ie_len; | |
8351 | struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils; | |
8352 | ||
8353 | const u8 *ap_mld_addr; | |
8354 | u16 valid_links; | |
8355 | struct { | |
8356 | const u8 *addr; | |
8357 | const u8 *bssid; | |
8358 | struct ieee80211_channel *channel; | |
8359 | struct cfg80211_bss *bss; | |
8360 | } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; | |
8361 | }; | |
8362 | ||
8363 | /** | |
8364 | * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming | |
8365 | * | |
8366 | * @dev: network device | |
8367 | * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info. | |
8368 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
8369 | * | |
8370 | * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the | |
8371 | * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry. | |
8372 | * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP | |
8373 | * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in | |
8374 | * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where | |
8375 | * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the | |
8376 | * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling | |
8377 | * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released | |
8378 | * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be | |
8379 | * released while disconnecting from the current bss. | |
8380 | */ | |
8381 | void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info, | |
8382 | gfp_t gfp); | |
8383 | ||
8384 | /** | |
8385 | * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association | |
8386 | * | |
8387 | * @dev: network device | |
8388 | * @peer_addr: BSSID of the AP/P2P GO in case of STA/GC or STA/GC MAC address | |
8389 | * in case of AP/P2P GO | |
8390 | * @td_bitmap: transition disable policy | |
8391 | * @td_bitmap_len: Length of transition disable policy | |
8392 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
8393 | * | |
8394 | * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake | |
8395 | * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e., | |
8396 | * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function | |
8397 | * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(), | |
8398 | * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to | |
8399 | * indicate the 802.11 association. | |
8400 | * This function can also be called by AP/P2P GO driver that supports | |
8401 | * authentication offload. In this case the peer_mac passed is that of | |
8402 | * associated STA/GC. | |
8403 | */ | |
8404 | void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer_addr, | |
8405 | const u8* td_bitmap, u8 td_bitmap_len, gfp_t gfp); | |
8406 | ||
8407 | /** | |
8408 | * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped | |
8409 | * | |
8410 | * @dev: network device | |
8411 | * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL) | |
8412 | * @ie_len: length of IEs | |
8413 | * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown | |
8414 | * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally | |
8415 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
8416 | * | |
8417 | * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state | |
8418 | * and not try to connect to any AP any more. | |
8419 | */ | |
8420 | void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason, | |
8421 | const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len, | |
8422 | bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp); | |
8423 | ||
8424 | /** | |
8425 | * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start | |
8426 | * @wdev: wireless device | |
8427 | * @cookie: the request cookie | |
8428 | * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request) | |
8429 | * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the | |
8430 | * channel | |
8431 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
8432 | */ | |
8433 | void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, | |
8434 | struct ieee80211_channel *chan, | |
8435 | unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp); | |
8436 | ||
8437 | /** | |
8438 | * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired | |
8439 | * @wdev: wireless device | |
8440 | * @cookie: the request cookie | |
8441 | * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request) | |
8442 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
8443 | */ | |
8444 | void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, | |
8445 | struct ieee80211_channel *chan, | |
8446 | gfp_t gfp); | |
8447 | ||
8448 | /** | |
8449 | * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired | |
8450 | * @wdev: wireless device | |
8451 | * @cookie: the requested cookie | |
8452 | * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request) | |
8453 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
8454 | */ | |
8455 | void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, | |
8456 | struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp); | |
8457 | ||
8458 | /** | |
8459 | * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics. | |
8460 | * | |
8461 | * @sinfo: the station information | |
8462 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
8463 | * | |
8464 | * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. | |
8465 | */ | |
8466 | int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); | |
8467 | ||
8468 | /** | |
8469 | * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info | |
8470 | * @sinfo: the station information | |
8471 | * | |
8472 | * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station | |
8473 | * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on | |
8474 | * the stack.) | |
8475 | */ | |
8476 | static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo) | |
8477 | { | |
8478 | kfree(sinfo->pertid); | |
8479 | } | |
8480 | ||
8481 | /** | |
8482 | * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station | |
8483 | * | |
8484 | * @dev: the netdev | |
8485 | * @mac_addr: the station's address | |
8486 | * @sinfo: the station information | |
8487 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
8488 | */ | |
8489 | void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, | |
8490 | struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); | |
8491 | ||
8492 | /** | |
8493 | * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station | |
8494 | * @dev: the netdev | |
8495 | * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used. | |
8496 | * @sinfo: the station information/statistics | |
8497 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
8498 | */ | |
8499 | void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, | |
8500 | struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); | |
8501 | ||
8502 | /** | |
8503 | * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station | |
8504 | * | |
8505 | * @dev: the netdev | |
8506 | * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used. | |
8507 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
8508 | */ | |
8509 | static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev, | |
8510 | const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp) | |
8511 | { | |
8512 | cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp); | |
8513 | } | |
8514 | ||
8515 | /** | |
8516 | * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification | |
8517 | * | |
8518 | * @dev: the netdev | |
8519 | * @mac_addr: the station's address | |
8520 | * @reason: the reason for connection failure | |
8521 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
8522 | * | |
8523 | * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station | |
8524 | * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection | |
8525 | * for some reasons, this function is called. | |
8526 | * | |
8527 | * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from | |
8528 | * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum | |
8529 | */ | |
8530 | void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, | |
8531 | enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason, | |
8532 | gfp_t gfp); | |
8533 | ||
8534 | /** | |
8535 | * struct cfg80211_rx_info - received management frame info | |
8536 | * | |
8537 | * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in kHz | |
8538 | * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown | |
8539 | * @have_link_id: indicates the frame was received on a link of | |
8540 | * an MLD, i.e. the @link_id field is valid | |
8541 | * @link_id: the ID of the link the frame was received on | |
8542 | * @buf: Management frame (header + body) | |
8543 | * @len: length of the frame data | |
8544 | * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags | |
8545 | * @rx_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of frame RX in nanoseconds | |
8546 | * @ack_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of ack TX in nanoseconds | |
8547 | */ | |
8548 | struct cfg80211_rx_info { | |
8549 | int freq; | |
8550 | int sig_dbm; | |
8551 | bool have_link_id; | |
8552 | u8 link_id; | |
8553 | const u8 *buf; | |
8554 | size_t len; | |
8555 | u32 flags; | |
8556 | u64 rx_tstamp; | |
8557 | u64 ack_tstamp; | |
8558 | }; | |
8559 | ||
8560 | /** | |
8561 | * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext - management frame notification with extended info | |
8562 | * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame | |
8563 | * @info: RX info as defined in struct cfg80211_rx_info | |
8564 | * | |
8565 | * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station | |
8566 | * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel. | |
8567 | * | |
8568 | * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame. | |
8569 | * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized | |
8570 | * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the | |
8571 | * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame. | |
8572 | */ | |
8573 | bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
8574 | struct cfg80211_rx_info *info); | |
8575 | ||
8576 | /** | |
8577 | * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame | |
8578 | * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame | |
8579 | * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz | |
8580 | * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown | |
8581 | * @buf: Management frame (header + body) | |
8582 | * @len: length of the frame data | |
8583 | * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags | |
8584 | * | |
8585 | * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station | |
8586 | * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel. | |
8587 | * | |
8588 | * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame. | |
8589 | * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized | |
8590 | * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the | |
8591 | * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame. | |
8592 | */ | |
8593 | static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, | |
8594 | int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len, | |
8595 | u32 flags) | |
8596 | { | |
8597 | struct cfg80211_rx_info info = { | |
8598 | .freq = freq, | |
8599 | .sig_dbm = sig_dbm, | |
8600 | .buf = buf, | |
8601 | .len = len, | |
8602 | .flags = flags | |
8603 | }; | |
8604 | ||
8605 | return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info); | |
8606 | } | |
8607 | ||
8608 | /** | |
8609 | * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame | |
8610 | * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame | |
8611 | * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz | |
8612 | * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown | |
8613 | * @buf: Management frame (header + body) | |
8614 | * @len: length of the frame data | |
8615 | * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags | |
8616 | * | |
8617 | * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station | |
8618 | * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel. | |
8619 | * | |
8620 | * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame. | |
8621 | * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized | |
8622 | * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the | |
8623 | * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame. | |
8624 | */ | |
8625 | static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, | |
8626 | int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len, | |
8627 | u32 flags) | |
8628 | { | |
8629 | struct cfg80211_rx_info info = { | |
8630 | .freq = MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq), | |
8631 | .sig_dbm = sig_dbm, | |
8632 | .buf = buf, | |
8633 | .len = len, | |
8634 | .flags = flags | |
8635 | }; | |
8636 | ||
8637 | return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info); | |
8638 | } | |
8639 | ||
8640 | /** | |
8641 | * struct cfg80211_tx_status - TX status for management frame information | |
8642 | * | |
8643 | * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() | |
8644 | * @tx_tstamp: hardware TX timestamp in nanoseconds | |
8645 | * @ack_tstamp: hardware ack RX timestamp in nanoseconds | |
8646 | * @buf: Management frame (header + body) | |
8647 | * @len: length of the frame data | |
8648 | * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged | |
8649 | */ | |
8650 | struct cfg80211_tx_status { | |
8651 | u64 cookie; | |
8652 | u64 tx_tstamp; | |
8653 | u64 ack_tstamp; | |
8654 | const u8 *buf; | |
8655 | size_t len; | |
8656 | bool ack; | |
8657 | }; | |
8658 | ||
8659 | /** | |
8660 | * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext - TX status notification with extended info | |
8661 | * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame | |
8662 | * @status: TX status data | |
8663 | * @gfp: context flags | |
8664 | * | |
8665 | * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be | |
8666 | * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the | |
8667 | * transmission attempt with extended info. | |
8668 | */ | |
8669 | void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
8670 | struct cfg80211_tx_status *status, gfp_t gfp); | |
8671 | ||
8672 | /** | |
8673 | * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame | |
8674 | * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame | |
8675 | * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() | |
8676 | * @buf: Management frame (header + body) | |
8677 | * @len: length of the frame data | |
8678 | * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged | |
8679 | * @gfp: context flags | |
8680 | * | |
8681 | * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be | |
8682 | * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the | |
8683 | * transmission attempt. | |
8684 | */ | |
8685 | static inline void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
8686 | u64 cookie, const u8 *buf, | |
8687 | size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp) | |
8688 | { | |
8689 | struct cfg80211_tx_status status = { | |
8690 | .cookie = cookie, | |
8691 | .buf = buf, | |
8692 | .len = len, | |
8693 | .ack = ack | |
8694 | }; | |
8695 | ||
8696 | cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(wdev, &status, gfp); | |
8697 | } | |
8698 | ||
8699 | /** | |
8700 | * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control | |
8701 | * port frames | |
8702 | * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame | |
8703 | * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() | |
8704 | * @buf: Data frame (header + body) | |
8705 | * @len: length of the frame data | |
8706 | * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged | |
8707 | * @gfp: context flags | |
8708 | * | |
8709 | * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be | |
8710 | * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of | |
8711 | * the transmission attempt. | |
8712 | */ | |
8713 | void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, | |
8714 | const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack, | |
8715 | gfp_t gfp); | |
8716 | ||
8717 | /** | |
8718 | * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame | |
8719 | * @dev: The device the frame matched to | |
8720 | * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame. It is assumed that the skbuf | |
8721 | * is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header). The skb can be non-linear. | |
8722 | * This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is | |
8723 | * responsible for any cleanup. The caller must also ensure that | |
8724 | * skb->protocol is set appropriately. | |
8725 | * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted | |
8726 | * @link_id: the link the frame was received on, -1 if not applicable or unknown | |
8727 | * | |
8728 | * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port | |
8729 | * frame. It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive | |
8730 | * control port frames over nl80211. | |
8731 | * | |
8732 | * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all | |
8733 | * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame). | |
8734 | * | |
8735 | * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace | |
8736 | */ | |
8737 | bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev, struct sk_buff *skb, | |
8738 | bool unencrypted, int link_id); | |
8739 | ||
8740 | /** | |
8741 | * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event | |
8742 | * @dev: network device | |
8743 | * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event | |
8744 | * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available | |
8745 | * @gfp: context flags | |
8746 | * | |
8747 | * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring | |
8748 | * rssi threshold reached event occurs. | |
8749 | */ | |
8750 | void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev, | |
8751 | enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event, | |
8752 | s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp); | |
8753 | ||
8754 | /** | |
8755 | * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer | |
8756 | * @dev: network device | |
8757 | * @peer: peer's MAC address | |
8758 | * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold | |
8759 | * but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent | |
8760 | * threshold (to account for temporary interference) | |
8761 | * @gfp: context flags | |
8762 | */ | |
8763 | void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev, | |
8764 | const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp); | |
8765 | ||
8766 | /** | |
8767 | * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event | |
8768 | * @dev: network device | |
8769 | * @peer: peer's MAC address | |
8770 | * @num_packets: how many packets were lost | |
8771 | * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission | |
8772 | * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached. | |
8773 | * @gfp: context flags | |
8774 | * | |
8775 | * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a | |
8776 | * given interval is exceeded. | |
8777 | */ | |
8778 | void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer, | |
8779 | u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp); | |
8780 | ||
8781 | /** | |
8782 | * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event | |
8783 | * @dev: network device | |
8784 | * @gfp: context flags | |
8785 | * | |
8786 | * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP. | |
8787 | */ | |
8788 | void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp); | |
8789 | ||
8790 | /** | |
8791 | * __cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event | |
8792 | * @wiphy: the wiphy | |
8793 | * @chandef: chandef for the current channel | |
8794 | * @offchan: the radar has been detected on the offchannel chain | |
8795 | * @gfp: context flags | |
8796 | * | |
8797 | * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl. | |
8798 | */ | |
8799 | void __cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
8800 | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | |
8801 | bool offchan, gfp_t gfp); | |
8802 | ||
8803 | static inline void | |
8804 | cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
8805 | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | |
8806 | gfp_t gfp) | |
8807 | { | |
8808 | __cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, false, gfp); | |
8809 | } | |
8810 | ||
8811 | static inline void | |
8812 | cfg80211_background_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
8813 | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | |
8814 | gfp_t gfp) | |
8815 | { | |
8816 | __cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, true, gfp); | |
8817 | } | |
8818 | ||
8819 | /** | |
8820 | * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event | |
8821 | * @dev: network device | |
8822 | * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified | |
8823 | * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value | |
8824 | * @gfp: context flags | |
8825 | * | |
8826 | * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action | |
8827 | * frame. | |
8828 | */ | |
8829 | void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac, | |
8830 | struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode, | |
8831 | gfp_t gfp); | |
8832 | ||
8833 | /** | |
8834 | * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event | |
8835 | * @netdev: network device | |
8836 | * @chandef: chandef for the current channel | |
8837 | * @event: type of event | |
8838 | * @gfp: context flags | |
8839 | * @link_id: valid link_id for MLO operation or 0 otherwise. | |
8840 | * | |
8841 | * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished | |
8842 | * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process, | |
8843 | * also by full-MAC drivers. | |
8844 | */ | |
8845 | void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev, | |
8846 | const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | |
8847 | enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp, | |
8848 | unsigned int link_id); | |
8849 | ||
8850 | /** | |
8851 | * cfg80211_background_cac_abort - Channel Availability Check offchan abort event | |
8852 | * @wiphy: the wiphy | |
8853 | * | |
8854 | * This function is called by the driver when a Channel Availability Check | |
8855 | * (CAC) is aborted by a offchannel dedicated chain. | |
8856 | */ | |
8857 | void cfg80211_background_cac_abort(struct wiphy *wiphy); | |
8858 | ||
8859 | /** | |
8860 | * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying | |
8861 | * @dev: network device | |
8862 | * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races) | |
8863 | * @replay_ctr: new replay counter | |
8864 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
8865 | */ | |
8866 | void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, | |
8867 | const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp); | |
8868 | ||
8869 | /** | |
8870 | * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate | |
8871 | * @dev: network device | |
8872 | * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority) | |
8873 | * @bssid: BSSID of AP | |
8874 | * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication | |
8875 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
8876 | */ | |
8877 | void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index, | |
8878 | const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp); | |
8879 | ||
8880 | /** | |
8881 | * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame | |
8882 | * @dev: The device the frame matched to | |
8883 | * @addr: the transmitter address | |
8884 | * @gfp: context flags | |
8885 | * | |
8886 | * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that | |
8887 | * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the | |
8888 | * sender. | |
8889 | * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed | |
8890 | * for a reason other than not having a subscription.) | |
8891 | */ | |
8892 | bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev, | |
8893 | const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp); | |
8894 | ||
8895 | /** | |
8896 | * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame | |
8897 | * @dev: The device the frame matched to | |
8898 | * @addr: the transmitter address | |
8899 | * @gfp: context flags | |
8900 | * | |
8901 | * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that | |
8902 | * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected. | |
8903 | * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each | |
8904 | * station to avoid event flooding. | |
8905 | * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed | |
8906 | * for a reason other than not having a subscription.) | |
8907 | */ | |
8908 | bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev, | |
8909 | const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp); | |
8910 | ||
8911 | /** | |
8912 | * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status | |
8913 | * @dev: the device the probe was sent on | |
8914 | * @addr: the address of the peer | |
8915 | * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously | |
8916 | * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not | |
8917 | * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame. | |
8918 | * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not. | |
8919 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
8920 | */ | |
8921 | void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr, | |
8922 | u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal, | |
8923 | bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp); | |
8924 | ||
8925 | /** | |
8926 | * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs | |
8927 | * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon | |
8928 | * @frame: the frame | |
8929 | * @len: length of the frame | |
8930 | * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz | |
8931 | * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown | |
8932 | * | |
8933 | * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was | |
8934 | * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no | |
8935 | * netdev that is in AP/GO mode. | |
8936 | */ | |
8937 | void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame, | |
8938 | size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm); | |
8939 | ||
8940 | /** | |
8941 | * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs | |
8942 | * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon | |
8943 | * @frame: the frame | |
8944 | * @len: length of the frame | |
8945 | * @freq: frequency the frame was received on | |
8946 | * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown | |
8947 | * | |
8948 | * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was | |
8949 | * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no | |
8950 | * netdev that is in AP/GO mode. | |
8951 | */ | |
8952 | static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
8953 | const u8 *frame, size_t len, | |
8954 | int freq, int sig_dbm) | |
8955 | { | |
8956 | cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq), | |
8957 | sig_dbm); | |
8958 | } | |
8959 | ||
8960 | /** | |
8961 | * struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config - beacon check configuration | |
8962 | * @iftype: the interface type to check for | |
8963 | * @relax: allow IR-relaxation conditions to apply (e.g. another | |
8964 | * interface connected already on the same channel) | |
8965 | * NOTE: If this is set, wiphy mutex must be held. | |
8966 | * @reg_power: &enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power value indicating the | |
8967 | * advertised/used 6 GHz regulatory power setting | |
8968 | */ | |
8969 | struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config { | |
8970 | enum nl80211_iftype iftype; | |
8971 | enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power reg_power; | |
8972 | bool relax; | |
8973 | }; | |
8974 | ||
8975 | /** | |
8976 | * cfg80211_reg_check_beaconing - check if beaconing is allowed | |
8977 | * @wiphy: the wiphy | |
8978 | * @chandef: the channel definition | |
8979 | * @cfg: additional parameters for the checking | |
8980 | * | |
8981 | * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s) | |
8982 | * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.) | |
8983 | */ | |
8984 | bool cfg80211_reg_check_beaconing(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
8985 | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | |
8986 | struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config *cfg); | |
8987 | ||
8988 | /** | |
8989 | * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed | |
8990 | * @wiphy: the wiphy | |
8991 | * @chandef: the channel definition | |
8992 | * @iftype: interface type | |
8993 | * | |
8994 | * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s) | |
8995 | * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.) | |
8996 | */ | |
8997 | static inline bool | |
8998 | cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
8999 | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | |
9000 | enum nl80211_iftype iftype) | |
9001 | { | |
9002 | struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config config = { | |
9003 | .iftype = iftype, | |
9004 | }; | |
9005 | ||
9006 | return cfg80211_reg_check_beaconing(wiphy, chandef, &config); | |
9007 | } | |
9008 | ||
9009 | /** | |
9010 | * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation | |
9011 | * @wiphy: the wiphy | |
9012 | * @chandef: the channel definition | |
9013 | * @iftype: interface type | |
9014 | * | |
9015 | * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s) | |
9016 | * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version | |
9017 | * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under | |
9018 | * more permissive conditions. | |
9019 | * | |
9020 | * Context: Requires the wiphy mutex to be held. | |
9021 | */ | |
9022 | static inline bool | |
9023 | cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
9024 | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | |
9025 | enum nl80211_iftype iftype) | |
9026 | { | |
9027 | struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config config = { | |
9028 | .iftype = iftype, | |
9029 | .relax = true, | |
9030 | }; | |
9031 | ||
9032 | return cfg80211_reg_check_beaconing(wiphy, chandef, &config); | |
9033 | } | |
9034 | ||
9035 | /** | |
9036 | * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace | |
9037 | * @dev: the device which switched channels | |
9038 | * @chandef: the new channel definition | |
9039 | * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO | |
9040 | * | |
9041 | * Caller must hold wiphy mutex, therefore must only be called from sleepable | |
9042 | * driver context! | |
9043 | */ | |
9044 | void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev, | |
9045 | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | |
9046 | unsigned int link_id); | |
9047 | ||
9048 | /** | |
9049 | * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start | |
9050 | * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started | |
9051 | * @chandef: the future channel definition | |
9052 | * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO | |
9053 | * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens | |
9054 | * @quiet: whether or not immediate quiet was requested by the AP | |
9055 | * | |
9056 | * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just | |
9057 | * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting | |
9058 | * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary. | |
9059 | */ | |
9060 | void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev, | |
9061 | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | |
9062 | unsigned int link_id, u8 count, | |
9063 | bool quiet); | |
9064 | ||
9065 | /** | |
9066 | * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band | |
9067 | * | |
9068 | * @operating_class: the operating class to convert | |
9069 | * @band: band pointer to fill | |
9070 | * | |
9071 | * Return: %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise. | |
9072 | */ | |
9073 | bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class, | |
9074 | enum nl80211_band *band); | |
9075 | ||
9076 | /** | |
9077 | * ieee80211_operating_class_to_chandef - convert operating class to chandef | |
9078 | * | |
9079 | * @operating_class: the operating class to convert | |
9080 | * @chan: the ieee80211_channel to convert | |
9081 | * @chandef: a pointer to the resulting chandef | |
9082 | * | |
9083 | * Return: %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise. | |
9084 | */ | |
9085 | bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_chandef(u8 operating_class, | |
9086 | struct ieee80211_channel *chan, | |
9087 | struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); | |
9088 | ||
9089 | /** | |
9090 | * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class | |
9091 | * | |
9092 | * @chandef: the chandef to convert | |
9093 | * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class | |
9094 | * | |
9095 | * Return: %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise. | |
9096 | */ | |
9097 | bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, | |
9098 | u8 *op_class); | |
9099 | ||
9100 | /** | |
9101 | * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz | |
9102 | * | |
9103 | * @chandef: the chandef to convert | |
9104 | * | |
9105 | * Return: the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz. | |
9106 | */ | |
9107 | static inline u32 | |
9108 | ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) | |
9109 | { | |
9110 | return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset; | |
9111 | } | |
9112 | ||
9113 | /** | |
9114 | * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation | |
9115 | * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested | |
9116 | * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device | |
9117 | * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or | |
9118 | * NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN) | |
9119 | * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request | |
9120 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
9121 | * | |
9122 | * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that | |
9123 | * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP | |
9124 | * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use | |
9125 | * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g., | |
9126 | * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer). | |
9127 | */ | |
9128 | void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer, | |
9129 | enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper, | |
9130 | u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp); | |
9131 | ||
9132 | /** | |
9133 | * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units) | |
9134 | * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from | |
9135 | * | |
9136 | * Return: calculated bitrate | |
9137 | */ | |
9138 | u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate); | |
9139 | ||
9140 | /** | |
9141 | * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev | |
9142 | * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove | |
9143 | * | |
9144 | * This function removes the device so it can no longer be used. It is necessary | |
9145 | * to call this function even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the device | |
9146 | * by calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also be called | |
9147 | * when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g. when the hardware device | |
9148 | * is unbound from the driver. | |
9149 | * | |
9150 | * Context: Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held. | |
9151 | */ | |
9152 | void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev); | |
9153 | ||
9154 | /** | |
9155 | * cfg80211_register_netdevice - register the given netdev | |
9156 | * @dev: the netdev to register | |
9157 | * | |
9158 | * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather | |
9159 | * than register_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL is | |
9160 | * held. Otherwise, both register_netdevice() and register_netdev() are usable | |
9161 | * instead as well. | |
9162 | * | |
9163 | * Context: Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held. | |
9164 | * | |
9165 | * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. | |
9166 | */ | |
9167 | int cfg80211_register_netdevice(struct net_device *dev); | |
9168 | ||
9169 | /** | |
9170 | * cfg80211_unregister_netdevice - unregister the given netdev | |
9171 | * @dev: the netdev to register | |
9172 | * | |
9173 | * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather | |
9174 | * than unregister_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL | |
9175 | * is held. Otherwise, both unregister_netdevice() and unregister_netdev() are | |
9176 | * usable instead as well. | |
9177 | * | |
9178 | * Context: Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held. | |
9179 | */ | |
9180 | static inline void cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device *dev) | |
9181 | { | |
9182 | #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211) | |
9183 | cfg80211_unregister_wdev(dev->ieee80211_ptr); | |
9184 | #endif | |
9185 | } | |
9186 | ||
9187 | /** | |
9188 | * struct cfg80211_ft_event_params - FT Information Elements | |
9189 | * @ies: FT IEs | |
9190 | * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes | |
9191 | * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address | |
9192 | * @ric_ies: RIC IE | |
9193 | * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes | |
9194 | */ | |
9195 | struct cfg80211_ft_event_params { | |
9196 | const u8 *ies; | |
9197 | size_t ies_len; | |
9198 | const u8 *target_ap; | |
9199 | const u8 *ric_ies; | |
9200 | size_t ric_ies_len; | |
9201 | }; | |
9202 | ||
9203 | /** | |
9204 | * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE | |
9205 | * @netdev: network device | |
9206 | * @ft_event: IE information | |
9207 | */ | |
9208 | void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev, | |
9209 | struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event); | |
9210 | ||
9211 | /** | |
9212 | * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer | |
9213 | * @ies: the input IE buffer | |
9214 | * @len: the input length | |
9215 | * @attr: the attribute ID to find | |
9216 | * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g. | |
9217 | * if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size | |
9218 | * @bufsize: size of the output buffer | |
9219 | * | |
9220 | * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and | |
9221 | * copies its contents to the given buffer. | |
9222 | * | |
9223 | * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is | |
9224 | * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the | |
9225 | * length of the found attribute (which can be zero). | |
9226 | */ | |
9227 | int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, | |
9228 | enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr, | |
9229 | u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize); | |
9230 | ||
9231 | /** | |
9232 | * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC) | |
9233 | * @ies: the IE buffer | |
9234 | * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer | |
9235 | * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before | |
9236 | * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next | |
9237 | * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE. | |
9238 | * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array | |
9239 | * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element | |
9240 | * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array | |
9241 | * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer | |
9242 | * | |
9243 | * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset | |
9244 | * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be | |
9245 | * split. | |
9246 | * | |
9247 | * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this | |
9248 | * has to be guaranteed by the caller! | |
9249 | * | |
9250 | * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered | |
9251 | * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not | |
9252 | * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering. | |
9253 | * | |
9254 | * Return: The offset where the next part of the buffer starts, which | |
9255 | * may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) of the buffer should be | |
9256 | * used. | |
9257 | */ | |
9258 | size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen, | |
9259 | const u8 *ids, int n_ids, | |
9260 | const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric, | |
9261 | size_t offset); | |
9262 | ||
9263 | /** | |
9264 | * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering | |
9265 | * @ies: the IE buffer | |
9266 | * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer | |
9267 | * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before | |
9268 | * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next | |
9269 | * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE. | |
9270 | * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array | |
9271 | * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer | |
9272 | * | |
9273 | * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset | |
9274 | * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be | |
9275 | * split. | |
9276 | * | |
9277 | * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this | |
9278 | * has to be guaranteed by the caller! | |
9279 | * | |
9280 | * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered | |
9281 | * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not | |
9282 | * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering. | |
9283 | * | |
9284 | * Return: The offset where the next part of the buffer starts, which | |
9285 | * may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) of the buffer should be | |
9286 | * used. | |
9287 | */ | |
9288 | static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen, | |
9289 | const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset) | |
9290 | { | |
9291 | return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset); | |
9292 | } | |
9293 | ||
9294 | /** | |
9295 | * ieee80211_fragment_element - fragment the last element in skb | |
9296 | * @skb: The skbuf that the element was added to | |
9297 | * @len_pos: Pointer to length of the element to fragment | |
9298 | * @frag_id: The element ID to use for fragments | |
9299 | * | |
9300 | * This function fragments all data after @len_pos, adding fragmentation | |
9301 | * elements with the given ID as appropriate. The SKB will grow in size | |
9302 | * accordingly. | |
9303 | */ | |
9304 | void ieee80211_fragment_element(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *len_pos, u8 frag_id); | |
9305 | ||
9306 | /** | |
9307 | * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN | |
9308 | * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup | |
9309 | * @wakeup: the wakeup report | |
9310 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
9311 | * | |
9312 | * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it | |
9313 | * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may | |
9314 | * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something | |
9315 | * else caused the wakeup. | |
9316 | */ | |
9317 | void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
9318 | struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup, | |
9319 | gfp_t gfp); | |
9320 | ||
9321 | /** | |
9322 | * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver. | |
9323 | * | |
9324 | * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped. | |
9325 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
9326 | * | |
9327 | * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted | |
9328 | * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given | |
9329 | * by .crit_proto_start() has expired. | |
9330 | */ | |
9331 | void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp); | |
9332 | ||
9333 | /** | |
9334 | * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has | |
9335 | * @wiphy: the wiphy | |
9336 | * | |
9337 | * Return: the number of channels supported by the device. | |
9338 | */ | |
9339 | unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy); | |
9340 | ||
9341 | /** | |
9342 | * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations | |
9343 | * | |
9344 | * @wiphy: the wiphy | |
9345 | * @params: the interface combinations parameter | |
9346 | * | |
9347 | * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a | |
9348 | * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to | |
9349 | * the interface combinations. | |
9350 | * | |
9351 | * Return: 0 if combinations are allowed. Non-zero on error. | |
9352 | */ | |
9353 | int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
9354 | struct iface_combination_params *params); | |
9355 | ||
9356 | /** | |
9357 | * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations | |
9358 | * | |
9359 | * @wiphy: the wiphy | |
9360 | * @params: the interface combinations parameter | |
9361 | * @iter: function to call for each matching combination | |
9362 | * @data: pointer to pass to iter function | |
9363 | * | |
9364 | * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible | |
9365 | * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching | |
9366 | * purposes. | |
9367 | * | |
9368 | * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. | |
9369 | */ | |
9370 | int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
9371 | struct iface_combination_params *params, | |
9372 | void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c, | |
9373 | void *data), | |
9374 | void *data); | |
9375 | ||
9376 | /** | |
9377 | * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection | |
9378 | * | |
9379 | * @wiphy: the wiphy | |
9380 | * @wdev: wireless device | |
9381 | * @gfp: context flags | |
9382 | * | |
9383 | * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA | |
9384 | * disconnected. | |
9385 | * | |
9386 | * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous. | |
9387 | */ | |
9388 | void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
9389 | gfp_t gfp); | |
9390 | ||
9391 | /** | |
9392 | * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy | |
9393 | * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down | |
9394 | * | |
9395 | * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by | |
9396 | * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed). | |
9397 | * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors | |
9398 | * that really can't be recovered in any other way. | |
9399 | * | |
9400 | * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into | |
9401 | * the driver while the function is running. | |
9402 | */ | |
9403 | void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy); | |
9404 | ||
9405 | /** | |
9406 | * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag | |
9407 | * | |
9408 | * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify. | |
9409 | * @ftidx: extended feature bit index. | |
9410 | * | |
9411 | * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see | |
9412 | * &struct wiphy.@ext_features) | |
9413 | */ | |
9414 | static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
9415 | enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx) | |
9416 | { | |
9417 | u8 *ft_byte; | |
9418 | ||
9419 | ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8]; | |
9420 | *ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8); | |
9421 | } | |
9422 | ||
9423 | /** | |
9424 | * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag | |
9425 | * | |
9426 | * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify. | |
9427 | * @ftidx: extended feature bit index. | |
9428 | * | |
9429 | * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see | |
9430 | * &struct wiphy.@ext_features) | |
9431 | * | |
9432 | * Return: %true if extended feature flag is set, %false otherwise | |
9433 | */ | |
9434 | static inline bool | |
9435 | wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
9436 | enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx) | |
9437 | { | |
9438 | u8 ft_byte; | |
9439 | ||
9440 | ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8]; | |
9441 | return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0; | |
9442 | } | |
9443 | ||
9444 | /** | |
9445 | * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function | |
9446 | * @f: NAN function that should be freed | |
9447 | * | |
9448 | * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members. | |
9449 | */ | |
9450 | void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f); | |
9451 | ||
9452 | /** | |
9453 | * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters | |
9454 | * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is | |
9455 | * %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber. | |
9456 | * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery | |
9457 | * result. | |
9458 | * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up. | |
9459 | * @inst_id: the local instance id | |
9460 | * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function | |
9461 | * @addr: the MAC address of the peer | |
9462 | * @info_len: the length of the &info | |
9463 | * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any) | |
9464 | * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function | |
9465 | */ | |
9466 | struct cfg80211_nan_match_params { | |
9467 | enum nl80211_nan_function_type type; | |
9468 | u8 inst_id; | |
9469 | u8 peer_inst_id; | |
9470 | const u8 *addr; | |
9471 | u8 info_len; | |
9472 | const u8 *info; | |
9473 | u64 cookie; | |
9474 | }; | |
9475 | ||
9476 | /** | |
9477 | * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function. | |
9478 | * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match | |
9479 | * @match: match notification parameters | |
9480 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
9481 | * | |
9482 | * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This | |
9483 | * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that | |
9484 | * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received. | |
9485 | */ | |
9486 | void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
9487 | struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp); | |
9488 | ||
9489 | /** | |
9490 | * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination. | |
9491 | * | |
9492 | * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match | |
9493 | * @inst_id: the local instance id | |
9494 | * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*) | |
9495 | * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier | |
9496 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
9497 | * | |
9498 | * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated. | |
9499 | */ | |
9500 | void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
9501 | u8 inst_id, | |
9502 | enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason, | |
9503 | u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp); | |
9504 | ||
9505 | /* ethtool helper */ | |
9506 | void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info); | |
9507 | ||
9508 | /** | |
9509 | * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication | |
9510 | * @netdev: network device | |
9511 | * @params: External authentication parameters | |
9512 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
9513 | * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error | |
9514 | */ | |
9515 | int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev, | |
9516 | struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params, | |
9517 | gfp_t gfp); | |
9518 | ||
9519 | /** | |
9520 | * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data | |
9521 | * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement | |
9522 | * @req: the original measurement request | |
9523 | * @result: the result data | |
9524 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
9525 | */ | |
9526 | void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
9527 | struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req, | |
9528 | struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result, | |
9529 | gfp_t gfp); | |
9530 | ||
9531 | /** | |
9532 | * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed | |
9533 | * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement | |
9534 | * @req: the original measurement request | |
9535 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
9536 | * | |
9537 | * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this | |
9538 | * the request pointer will no longer be valid. | |
9539 | */ | |
9540 | void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev, | |
9541 | struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req, | |
9542 | gfp_t gfp); | |
9543 | ||
9544 | /** | |
9545 | * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed | |
9546 | * @wiphy: the wiphy | |
9547 | * @iftype: interface type | |
9548 | * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1' | |
9549 | * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces | |
9550 | * | |
9551 | * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API | |
9552 | * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when | |
9553 | * check_swif is '1'. | |
9554 | * | |
9555 | * Return: %true if allowed, %false otherwise | |
9556 | */ | |
9557 | bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, | |
9558 | bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif); | |
9559 | ||
9560 | ||
9561 | /** | |
9562 | * cfg80211_assoc_comeback - notification of association that was | |
9563 | * temporarily rejected with a comeback | |
9564 | * @netdev: network device | |
9565 | * @ap_addr: AP (MLD) address that rejected the association | |
9566 | * @timeout: timeout interval value TUs. | |
9567 | * | |
9568 | * this function may sleep. the caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. | |
9569 | */ | |
9570 | void cfg80211_assoc_comeback(struct net_device *netdev, | |
9571 | const u8 *ap_addr, u32 timeout); | |
9572 | ||
9573 | /* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */ | |
9574 | ||
9575 | /* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */ | |
9576 | ||
9577 | #define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...) \ | |
9578 | dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) | |
9579 | #define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...) \ | |
9580 | dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) | |
9581 | #define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...) \ | |
9582 | dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) | |
9583 | #define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...) \ | |
9584 | dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) | |
9585 | #define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...) \ | |
9586 | dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) | |
9587 | #define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...) \ | |
9588 | dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) | |
9589 | #define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...) \ | |
9590 | dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) | |
9591 | #define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...) \ | |
9592 | dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) | |
9593 | #define wiphy_info_once(wiphy, format, args...) \ | |
9594 | dev_info_once(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) | |
9595 | ||
9596 | #define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \ | |
9597 | dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) | |
9598 | #define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \ | |
9599 | dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) | |
9600 | ||
9601 | #define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...) \ | |
9602 | wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args) | |
9603 | ||
9604 | #define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...) \ | |
9605 | dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) | |
9606 | ||
9607 | #if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG) | |
9608 | #define wiphy_vdbg wiphy_dbg | |
9609 | #else | |
9610 | #define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...) \ | |
9611 | ({ \ | |
9612 | if (0) \ | |
9613 | wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args); \ | |
9614 | 0; \ | |
9615 | }) | |
9616 | #endif | |
9617 | ||
9618 | /* | |
9619 | * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference | |
9620 | * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the | |
9621 | * file/line information and a backtrace. | |
9622 | */ | |
9623 | #define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...) \ | |
9624 | WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args); | |
9625 | ||
9626 | /** | |
9627 | * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space | |
9628 | * @netdev: network device | |
9629 | * @owe_info: peer's owe info | |
9630 | * @gfp: allocation flags | |
9631 | */ | |
9632 | void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev, | |
9633 | struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info, | |
9634 | gfp_t gfp); | |
9635 | ||
9636 | /** | |
9637 | * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries | |
9638 | * @wiphy: the wiphy | |
9639 | */ | |
9640 | void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy); | |
9641 | ||
9642 | /** | |
9643 | * cfg80211_bss_color_notify - notify about bss color event | |
9644 | * @dev: network device | |
9645 | * @cmd: the actual event we want to notify | |
9646 | * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens | |
9647 | * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of | |
9648 | * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO. | |
9649 | * | |
9650 | * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. | |
9651 | */ | |
9652 | int cfg80211_bss_color_notify(struct net_device *dev, | |
9653 | enum nl80211_commands cmd, u8 count, | |
9654 | u64 color_bitmap, u8 link_id); | |
9655 | ||
9656 | /** | |
9657 | * cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify about bss color collision | |
9658 | * @dev: network device | |
9659 | * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of | |
9660 | * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO. | |
9661 | * | |
9662 | * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. | |
9663 | */ | |
9664 | static inline int cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct net_device *dev, | |
9665 | u64 color_bitmap, | |
9666 | u8 link_id) | |
9667 | { | |
9668 | return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION, | |
9669 | 0, color_bitmap, link_id); | |
9670 | } | |
9671 | ||
9672 | /** | |
9673 | * cfg80211_color_change_started_notify - notify color change start | |
9674 | * @dev: the device on which the color is switched | |
9675 | * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens | |
9676 | * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO. | |
9677 | * | |
9678 | * Inform the userspace about the color change that has started. | |
9679 | * | |
9680 | * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. | |
9681 | */ | |
9682 | static inline int cfg80211_color_change_started_notify(struct net_device *dev, | |
9683 | u8 count, u8 link_id) | |
9684 | { | |
9685 | return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED, | |
9686 | count, 0, link_id); | |
9687 | } | |
9688 | ||
9689 | /** | |
9690 | * cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify - notify color change abort | |
9691 | * @dev: the device on which the color is switched | |
9692 | * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO. | |
9693 | * | |
9694 | * Inform the userspace about the color change that has aborted. | |
9695 | * | |
9696 | * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. | |
9697 | */ | |
9698 | static inline int cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify(struct net_device *dev, | |
9699 | u8 link_id) | |
9700 | { | |
9701 | return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED, | |
9702 | 0, 0, link_id); | |
9703 | } | |
9704 | ||
9705 | /** | |
9706 | * cfg80211_color_change_notify - notify color change completion | |
9707 | * @dev: the device on which the color was switched | |
9708 | * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO. | |
9709 | * | |
9710 | * Inform the userspace about the color change that has completed. | |
9711 | * | |
9712 | * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. | |
9713 | */ | |
9714 | static inline int cfg80211_color_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, | |
9715 | u8 link_id) | |
9716 | { | |
9717 | return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, | |
9718 | NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED, | |
9719 | 0, 0, link_id); | |
9720 | } | |
9721 | ||
9722 | /** | |
9723 | * cfg80211_links_removed - Notify about removed STA MLD setup links. | |
9724 | * @dev: network device. | |
9725 | * @link_mask: BIT mask of removed STA MLD setup link IDs. | |
9726 | * | |
9727 | * Inform cfg80211 and the userspace about removed STA MLD setup links due to | |
9728 | * AP MLD removing the corresponding affiliated APs with Multi-Link | |
9729 | * reconfiguration. Note that it's not valid to remove all links, in this | |
9730 | * case disconnect instead. | |
9731 | * Also note that the wdev mutex must be held. | |
9732 | */ | |
9733 | void cfg80211_links_removed(struct net_device *dev, u16 link_mask); | |
9734 | ||
9735 | /** | |
9736 | * struct cfg80211_mlo_reconf_done_data - MLO reconfiguration data | |
9737 | * @buf: MLO Reconfiguration Response frame (header + body) | |
9738 | * @len: length of the frame data | |
9739 | * @added_links: BIT mask of links successfully added to the association | |
9740 | * @links: per-link information indexed by link ID | |
9741 | * @links.bss: the BSS that MLO reconfiguration was requested for, ownership of | |
9742 | * the pointer moves to cfg80211 in the call to | |
9743 | * cfg80211_mlo_reconf_add_done(). | |
9744 | * | |
9745 | * The BSS pointer must be set for each link for which 'add' operation was | |
9746 | * requested in the assoc_ml_reconf callback. | |
9747 | */ | |
9748 | struct cfg80211_mlo_reconf_done_data { | |
9749 | const u8 *buf; | |
9750 | size_t len; | |
9751 | u16 added_links; | |
9752 | struct { | |
9753 | struct cfg80211_bss *bss; | |
9754 | u8 *addr; | |
9755 | } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; | |
9756 | }; | |
9757 | ||
9758 | /** | |
9759 | * cfg80211_mlo_reconf_add_done - Notify about MLO reconfiguration result | |
9760 | * @dev: network device. | |
9761 | * @data: MLO reconfiguration done data, &struct cfg80211_mlo_reconf_done_data | |
9762 | * | |
9763 | * Inform cfg80211 and the userspace that processing of ML reconfiguration | |
9764 | * request to add links to the association is done. | |
9765 | */ | |
9766 | void cfg80211_mlo_reconf_add_done(struct net_device *dev, | |
9767 | struct cfg80211_mlo_reconf_done_data *data); | |
9768 | ||
9769 | /** | |
9770 | * cfg80211_schedule_channels_check - schedule regulatory check if needed | |
9771 | * @wdev: the wireless device to check | |
9772 | * | |
9773 | * In case the device supports NO_IR or DFS relaxations, schedule regulatory | |
9774 | * channels check, as previous concurrent operation conditions may not | |
9775 | * hold anymore. | |
9776 | */ | |
9777 | void cfg80211_schedule_channels_check(struct wireless_dev *wdev); | |
9778 | ||
9779 | /** | |
9780 | * cfg80211_epcs_changed - Notify about a change in EPCS state | |
9781 | * @netdev: the wireless device whose EPCS state changed | |
9782 | * @enabled: set to true if EPCS was enabled, otherwise set to false. | |
9783 | */ | |
9784 | void cfg80211_epcs_changed(struct net_device *netdev, bool enabled); | |
9785 | ||
9786 | #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_DEBUGFS | |
9787 | /** | |
9788 | * wiphy_locked_debugfs_read - do a locked read in debugfs | |
9789 | * @wiphy: the wiphy to use | |
9790 | * @file: the file being read | |
9791 | * @buf: the buffer to fill and then read from | |
9792 | * @bufsize: size of the buffer | |
9793 | * @userbuf: the user buffer to copy to | |
9794 | * @count: read count | |
9795 | * @ppos: read position | |
9796 | * @handler: the read handler to call (under wiphy lock) | |
9797 | * @data: additional data to pass to the read handler | |
9798 | * | |
9799 | * Return: the number of characters read, or a negative errno | |
9800 | */ | |
9801 | ssize_t wiphy_locked_debugfs_read(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct file *file, | |
9802 | char *buf, size_t bufsize, | |
9803 | char __user *userbuf, size_t count, | |
9804 | loff_t *ppos, | |
9805 | ssize_t (*handler)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
9806 | struct file *file, | |
9807 | char *buf, | |
9808 | size_t bufsize, | |
9809 | void *data), | |
9810 | void *data); | |
9811 | ||
9812 | /** | |
9813 | * wiphy_locked_debugfs_write - do a locked write in debugfs | |
9814 | * @wiphy: the wiphy to use | |
9815 | * @file: the file being written to | |
9816 | * @buf: the buffer to copy the user data to | |
9817 | * @bufsize: size of the buffer | |
9818 | * @userbuf: the user buffer to copy from | |
9819 | * @count: read count | |
9820 | * @handler: the write handler to call (under wiphy lock) | |
9821 | * @data: additional data to pass to the write handler | |
9822 | * | |
9823 | * Return: the number of characters written, or a negative errno | |
9824 | */ | |
9825 | ssize_t wiphy_locked_debugfs_write(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct file *file, | |
9826 | char *buf, size_t bufsize, | |
9827 | const char __user *userbuf, size_t count, | |
9828 | ssize_t (*handler)(struct wiphy *wiphy, | |
9829 | struct file *file, | |
9830 | char *buf, | |
9831 | size_t count, | |
9832 | void *data), | |
9833 | void *data); | |
9834 | #endif | |
9835 | ||
9836 | #endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */ |